cceba7926059f75ba635c8c36af25e2a847513e1
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @section Board Config Files
1363 @cindex config file, board
1364 @cindex board config file
1365
1366 The user config file
1367 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1368
1369 @example
1370 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1371 @end example
1372
1373 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1374 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1375 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1376
1377 @enumerate
1378 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1379 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1380 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1381 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1382 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1383 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1384 @end enumerate
1385
1386 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1387 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1388 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1389 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1390
1391 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1392 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1393 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1394 configuration works.
1395
1396 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1397
1398 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1399 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1400 convention on how to use certain variables.
1401
1402 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1403 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1404 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1405 used at will within a target configuration file.
1406
1407 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1408 for a board with three chips:
1409
1410 @example
1411 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1412 set CHIPNAME network
1413 set ENDIAN big
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1420 set CHIPNAME video
1421 set ENDIAN little
1422 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1423 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1424 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1425 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1426
1427 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1428 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1429 unset ENDIAN
1430 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1431 @end example
1432
1433 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1434 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1435 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1436 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1437 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1438 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1439 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1440 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1441
1442 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1443 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1444 naming collisions.
1445
1446 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1447 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1448 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1449 up other clocks and peripherals.
1450
1451 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1452 @cindex variable names
1453
1454 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1455 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1456 one such chip (as shown above).
1457 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1458 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1459 to promote consistency and
1460 so that board files can override target defaults.
1461
1462 Inputs to target config files include:
1463
1464 @itemize @bullet
1465 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1466 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1467 tap identifier dotted names.
1468 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1469 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1470 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1471 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1472 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1473 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1474 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1475 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1476 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1477 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1478 @end itemize
1479
1480 Outputs from target config files include:
1481
1482 @itemize @bullet
1483 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1484 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1485 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1486 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1487 specific to that board and that target.
1488 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1489 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1490 @end itemize
1491
1492 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1493 @cindex event, reset-init
1494 @cindex reset-init handler
1495
1496 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1497 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1498 fully set up yet.
1499 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1500 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1501 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1502 handler is one of the most important.
1503
1504 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1505 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1506 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1507 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1508 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1509
1510 @quotation Note
1511 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1512 are included here.
1513 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1514 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1515 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1516 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1517 @end quotation
1518
1519 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1520 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1521 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1522 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1523 those as parameters.
1524 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1525 and disabling the watchdog.
1526 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1527 the next developer doing such work.
1528 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1529
1530 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1531 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1532 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1533 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1534
1535 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1536
1537 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1538 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1539 a low JTAG clock rate.
1540 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1541 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1542 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1543 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1544 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1545 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1546 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1547
1548 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1549 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1550 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1551 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1552 which might be less than that.
1553
1554 @quotation Warning
1555 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1556 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1557 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1558 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1559 @end quotation
1560
1561 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1562 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1563 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1564 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1565 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1566 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1567
1568 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1569 @subsection The init_board procedure
1570 @cindex init_board procedure
1571
1572 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1573 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1574 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1575 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1576 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1577 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1578 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1579 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1580 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1581 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1582 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1583 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1584
1585 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1586 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1587
1588 @example
1589 ### board_file.cfg ###
1590
1591 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1592 source [find target/target.cfg]
1593
1594 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1595 # enables fast on-board clock source
1596 # configures the chip to use it
1597 @}
1598
1599 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1600 proc init_board @{@} @{
1601 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1602
1603 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1604 adapter speed 100
1605 @}
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1608 enable_fast_clock
1609 adapter speed 10000
1610 @}
1611 @}
1612 @end example
1613
1614 @section Target Config Files
1615 @cindex config file, target
1616 @cindex target config file
1617
1618 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1619 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1620 more target config files like this:
1621
1622 @example
1623 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1624 @end example
1625
1626 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1627 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1628 In summary the target files should contain
1629
1630 @enumerate
1631 @item Set defaults
1632 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1633 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1634 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1635 @item On-Chip flash
1636 @end enumerate
1637
1638 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1639 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1640 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1641
1642 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1643 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1644 can talk to the chip.
1645 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1646 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1647 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1648 and other processing engines.
1649
1650 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1651
1652 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1653 letting board config files express environment-specific
1654 differences in how things should be set up.
1655
1656 @example
1657 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1658 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1659 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1660 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1661 @} else @{
1662 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1663 @}
1664
1665 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1666 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1667 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1668 @} else @{
1669 set _ENDIAN little
1670 @}
1671
1672 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1673 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1674 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1675 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1676 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1677 @} else @{
1678 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1679 @}
1680 @end example
1681 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1682
1683 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1684 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1685 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1686
1687 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1688 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1689 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1690
1691 @example
1692 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1693 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1694 @end example
1695
1696 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1697 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1698 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1699 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1700 for taps.
1701
1702 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1703 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1704 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1705 looks (in part) like this:
1706
1707 @example
1708 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1709 @end example
1710
1711 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1712 to source such a config file twice, with different
1713 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1714 it adds a different TAP each time.
1715
1716 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1717 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1718 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1719 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1720
1721 @example
1722 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1723 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1724 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1725 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1726 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1727 @end example
1728
1729 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1730 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1731
1732 @itemize
1733 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1734 plus a JRC to enable them
1735 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1736 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1737 is not currently used)
1738 @end itemize
1739
1740 @subsection Add CPU targets
1741
1742 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1743 GDB and other commands can use it.
1744 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1745 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1746 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1747 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1748
1749 @example
1750 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1751 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1752 @end example
1753
1754 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1755 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1756 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1757 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1758 a work area if you can.
1759 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1760
1761 @example
1762 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1763 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1764 @end example
1765
1766 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1767 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1768 @cindex SMP
1769 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1773 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1775 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1776 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1777 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1778 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1779 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1780 @end example
1781 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1782 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1785 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1786 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1787 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1788 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1789 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1793 command have been implemented.
1794 @itemize @bullet
1795 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1796 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1797 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1798 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1799 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2044 @section Entering the Run Stage
2045
2046 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2047 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2048 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2049 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2050 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2051 You should see no errors at this point.
2052 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2053 commands you used to configure the server.
2054 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2055 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2056 on the scan chain.
2057
2058 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2059 become available.
2060 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2061 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2062 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2063 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2064 entry to the run stage.
2065
2066 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2067 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2068 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2069 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2070 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2071 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2072 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2073
2074 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2075 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2076 configuration files and/or command line options.
2077
2078 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs near the end of your
2079 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2080 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2081 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2082 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2083
2084 @command{init} calls the following internal OpenOCD commands to initialize
2085 corresponding subsystems:
2086 @deffn {Config Command} {target init}
2087 @deffnx {Command} {transport init}
2088 @deffnx {Command} {dap init}
2089 @deffnx {Config Command} {flash init}
2090 @deffnx {Config Command} {nand init}
2091 @deffnx {Config Command} {pld init}
2092 @deffnx {Command} {tpiu init}
2093 @end deffn
2094 @end deffn
2095
2096 @deffn {Config Command} {noinit}
2097 Prevent OpenOCD from implicit @command{init} call at the end of startup.
2098 Allows issuing configuration commands over telnet or Tcl connection.
2099 When you are done with configuration use @command{init} to enter
2100 the run stage.
2101 @end deffn
2102
2103 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2104 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2105 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2106
2107 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2108 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2109 scan chain.
2110 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2111 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2112
2113 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2114 they return.
2115 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2116 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2117 @end deffn
2118
2119 @anchor{tcpipports}
2120 @section TCP/IP Ports
2121 @cindex TCP port
2122 @cindex server
2123 @cindex port
2124 @cindex security
2125 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2126 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2127 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2128
2129 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2130 access using one or more of these ports.
2131 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2132 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2133 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2134
2135 @anchor{gdb_port}
2136 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2137 @cindex GDB server
2138 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2139 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2140 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2141 the normal use cases.
2142
2143 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2144 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2145 disables the gdb server.
2146
2147 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2148 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2149
2150 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2151 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2152 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2153
2154 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2155 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2156 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2157 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2158 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2159 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2160 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2161 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2162 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2163
2164 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2165 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2166 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2167 @end deffn
2168
2169 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2170 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2171 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2172 output from the Tcl engine.
2173 Intended as a machine interface.
2174 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2175 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2176 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2177 @end deffn
2178
2179 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2180 Specify or query the
2181 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2182 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2183 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2184 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2185 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2186 @end deffn
2187
2188 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2189 @section GDB Configuration
2190 @cindex GDB
2191 @cindex GDB configuration
2192 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2193 The ones listed here are static and global.
2194 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2195 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2196
2197 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2198 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2199 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2200 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2201 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2202 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2203 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2204 @end deffn
2205
2206 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2207 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2208 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2209 vFlash packet is received.
2210 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2211 @end deffn
2212
2213 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2214 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2215 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2216 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2217 for flash programming to work.
2218 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2219 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2220 @end deffn
2221
2222 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2223 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2224 by GDB memory read packets.
2225 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2226 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2230 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2231 packets report errors or not.
2232 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2233 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2234 @end deffn
2235
2236 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2237 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2238 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2239 @end deffn
2240
2241 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2242 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2243
2244 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2245 @end deffn
2246
2247 @anchor{eventpolling}
2248 @section Event Polling
2249
2250 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2251 where significant events can happen at any time.
2252 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2253 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2254 or to GDB.
2255
2256 Examples of such events include:
2257
2258 @itemize
2259 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2260 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2261 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2262 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2263 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2264 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2265 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2266 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2267 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2268 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2269 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2270 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2271 @end itemize
2272
2273 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2274 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2275 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2276 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2277 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2278
2279 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2280 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2281 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2282 to the various active targets.
2283 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2284 which is normally done in the background.
2285
2286 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2287 Poll the current target for its current state.
2288 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2289 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2290 specific information about the current state is printed.
2291 An optional parameter
2292 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2293
2294 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2295 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2296 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2297 @example
2298 > poll
2299 background polling: on
2300 target state: halted
2301 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2302 current mode: Supervisor
2303 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2304 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2305 >
2306 @end example
2307 @end deffn
2308
2309 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2310 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2311 @cindex config file, interface
2312 @cindex interface config file
2313
2314 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2315 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2316 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2317
2318 @quotation Note
2319 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2320 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2321 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2322 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2323 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2324 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2325 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2326 @end quotation
2327
2328 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2329 through commands in an interface configuration
2330 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2331 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2332
2333 @example
2334 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2335 @end example
2336
2337 These commands tell
2338 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2339 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2340
2341 @example
2342 # jlink interface
2343 adapter driver jlink
2344 @end example
2345
2346 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2347
2348
2349 @section Adapter Configuration
2350
2351 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2352 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2353 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2354
2355 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2356 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2357 target.
2358 @end deffn
2359
2360 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2361 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2362 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2363 @end deffn
2364 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2365 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2366 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2367 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2368 the hardware can support.
2369 @end deffn
2370
2371
2372
2373 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2374 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2375 @end deffn
2376
2377 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2378 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2379 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2380 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2381 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2382 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2383 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2384
2385 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2386 @end deffn
2387
2388 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2389 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2390 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2391 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2392 aice (aice_usb), arm-jtag-ew, cmsis_dap, ft232r, ftdi, hla (stlink, ti-icdi), jlink, kitprog, opendus,
2393 openjtag, osbdm, presto, rlink, st-link, usb_blaster (ublast2), usbprog, vsllink, xds110.
2394 @end deffn
2395
2396 @section Interface Drivers
2397
2398 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2399 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2400 available at run time.
2401
2402 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2403 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2404 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2405 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2406
2407 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2408 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2409 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2410 @end deffn
2411
2412 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2413 Displays status of RTCK option.
2414 Optionally sets that option first.
2415 @end deffn
2416 @end deffn
2417
2418 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2419 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2420 This has one driver-specific command:
2421
2422 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2423 Logs some status
2424 @end deffn
2425 @end deffn
2426
2427 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2428 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2429 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2430 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2431 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2432 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2433 @end deffn
2434
2435 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2436 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2437 or v2 (USB bulk).
2438
2439 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2440 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2441 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2442 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2443 @example
2444 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2445 @end example
2446 @end deffn
2447
2448 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2449 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2450
2451 @itemize @minus
2452 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2453 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2454 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2455 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2456 @end itemize
2457 @end deffn
2458
2459 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2460 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2461 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2462 interface string or for user class interface.
2463 @end deffn
2464
2465 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2466 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2467 @end deffn
2468
2469 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap cmd} number number ...
2470 Execute an arbitrary CMSIS-DAP command. Use for adapter testing or for handling
2471 of an adapter vendor specific command from a Tcl script.
2472
2473 Take given numbers as bytes, assemble a CMSIS-DAP protocol command packet
2474 from them and send it to the adapter. The first 4 bytes of the adapter response
2475 are logged.
2476 See @url{https://arm-software.github.io/CMSIS_5/DAP/html/group__DAP__Commands__gr.html}
2477 @end deffn
2478 @end deffn
2479
2480 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2481 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2482 @end deffn
2483
2484 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2485 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2486 @end deffn
2487
2488 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2489 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2490 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2491
2492 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2493 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2494
2495 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2496 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2497
2498 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2499 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2500 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2501 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2502 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2503 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2504
2505 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2506 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2507 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2508 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2509 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2510
2511 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2512 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2513 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2514 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2515
2516 @itemize @minus
2517 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2518 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2519 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2520 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2521 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2522 switching data and direction as necessary
2523 @end itemize
2524
2525 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2526 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2527
2528 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2529 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2530 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2531 @example
2532 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2533 @end example
2534 @end deffn
2535
2536 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2537 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2538 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2539 during device selection.
2540 @end deffn
2541
2542 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2543 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2544 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2545 @end deffn
2546
2547 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2548 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2549 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2550 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2551 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2552 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2553 and initially asserted reset signals.
2554 @end deffn
2555
2556 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2557 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2558 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2559 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2560 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2561 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2562 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2563 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2564 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2565 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2566 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2567
2568 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2569 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2570 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2571 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2572 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2573 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2574
2575 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2576 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2577 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2578 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2579 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2580 are always driven by the FTDI.
2581
2582 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2583 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2584 @var{name}.
2585 @end deffn
2586
2587 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2588 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2589 @itemize @minus
2590 @item @option{0}, drive low
2591 @item @option{1}, drive high
2592 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2593 @end itemize
2594 @end deffn
2595
2596 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2597 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2598 @end deffn
2599
2600 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2601 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2602
2603 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2604 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2605 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2606 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2607 @itemize @minus
2608 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2609 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2610 @end itemize
2611 @end deffn
2612
2613 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2614 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2615
2616 @end deffn
2617
2618 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2619 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2620 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2621 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2622
2623 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2624 @itemize @minus
2625 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2626 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2627 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2628 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2629 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2630 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2631 @end itemize
2632
2633 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2634 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2635 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2636 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2637 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2638 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2639 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2640 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2641
2642 FT232R
2643 @itemize @minus
2644 @item bit 7 - RI
2645 @item bit 6 - DCD
2646 @item bit 5 - DSR
2647 @item bit 4 - DTR
2648 @item bit 3 - CTS
2649 @item bit 2 - RTS
2650 @item bit 1 - RXD
2651 @item bit 0 - TXD
2652 @end itemize
2653
2654 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2655 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2656
2657 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2658 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2659 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2660 @end deffn
2661
2662 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2663 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2664 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2665 @end deffn
2666
2667 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2668 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2669 @end deffn
2670
2671 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2672 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2673 @end deffn
2674
2675 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2676 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2677 @end deffn
2678
2679 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2680 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2681 @end deffn
2682
2683 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2684 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2685 @end deffn
2686
2687 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2688 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2689 @end deffn
2690
2691 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2692 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2693 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2694 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2695 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2696 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2697 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2698 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2699 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2700 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2701 @end deffn
2702
2703 @end deffn
2704
2705 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2706 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2707 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2708 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2709
2710 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2711 processors which are being simulated.
2712
2713 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2714 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2715 sockets instead of TCP.
2716 @end deffn
2717
2718 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2719 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2720 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2721 @end deffn
2722
2723 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2724 something like:
2725
2726 @example
2727 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2728 remote_bitbang port 3335
2729 remote_bitbang host foobar
2730 @end example
2731
2732 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2733 named mysocket:
2734
2735 @example
2736 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2737 remote_bitbang port 0
2738 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2739 @end example
2740 @end deffn
2741
2742 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2743 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2744 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2745 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2746
2747 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2748 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2749 default values are used.
2750 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2751 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2752 @example
2753 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2754 @end example
2755 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2756 @example
2757 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2758 @end example
2759 @end deffn
2760
2761 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2762 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2763 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2764 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2765 target board.
2766
2767 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2768 @example
2769 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2770 reset_config srst_only
2771 @end example
2772 @end deffn
2773
2774 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2775 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2776 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2777 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2778 @end deffn
2779
2780 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2781 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2782 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2783 @end deffn
2784
2785 @end deffn
2786
2787 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2788 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2789 This has one driver-specific command:
2790
2791 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2792 Display either the address of the I/O port
2793 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2794 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2795 This is a write-once setting.
2796 @end deffn
2797 @end deffn
2798
2799 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2800 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2801 transports.
2802
2803 @quotation Compatibility Note
2804 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2805 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2806 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2807 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2808 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2809 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2810 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2811 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2812 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2813 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2814 @end quotation
2815
2816 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2817 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2818 states.
2819 @end deffn
2820 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2821 Display free device internal memory.
2822 @end deffn
2823 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2824 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2825 command version.
2826 @end deffn
2827 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2828 Display the device configuration.
2829 @end deffn
2830 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2831 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2832 power state.
2833 @end deffn
2834 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2835 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2836 @end deffn
2837 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2838 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2839 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2840 IP configuration.
2841 @end deffn
2842 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2843 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2844 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2845 @end deffn
2846 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2847 Reset the current configuration.
2848 @end deffn
2849 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2850 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2851 @end deffn
2852 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2853 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2854 pairs.
2855
2856 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2857 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2858 @example
2859 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2860 @end example
2861 @end deffn
2862 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2863 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2864 pairs.
2865
2866 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2867 @example
2868 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2869 77a90000
2870 @end example
2871 @end deffn
2872 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2873 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2874 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2875 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2876 the serial number instead, if possible.
2877
2878 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2879 @end deffn
2880 @end deffn
2881
2882 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2883 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2884 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2885 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2886 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2887 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2888 configuration script.
2889
2890 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2891 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2892 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2893 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2894 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2895
2896 Known limitations:
2897 @itemize @bullet
2898 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2899 and 2.7 MHz.
2900 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2901 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2902 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2903 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2904 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2905 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2906 communications with the target.
2907 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2908 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2909 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2910 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2911 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2912 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2913 @end itemize
2914
2915 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2916 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2917 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2918 @end deffn
2919
2920 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2921 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2922 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2923 target as a side-effect.
2924 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2925 @end deffn
2926
2927 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2928 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2929 version, and target voltage.
2930 @end deffn
2931 @end deffn
2932
2933 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2934 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2935 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2936 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2937 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2938
2939 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
2940 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2941 This is a write-once setting.
2942 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2943
2944 @itemize @minus
2945 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2946 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2947 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2948 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2949 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2950 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2951 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2952 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2953 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2954 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2955 some versions of
2956 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2957 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2958 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2959 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2960 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2961 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2962 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2963 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2964 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2965 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2966 @end itemize
2967 @end deffn
2968
2969 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2970 Display either the address of the I/O port
2971 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2972 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2973 This is a write-once setting.
2974
2975 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2976 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
2977 you may encounter a problem.
2978 @end deffn
2979
2980 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2981 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2982 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2983 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2984 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2985 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2986
2987 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2988 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2989 @quotation Tip
2990 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2991 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2992 @example
2993 > parport toggling_time 1000
2994 > adapter speed 500
2995 @end example
2996 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2997 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2998 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2999 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3000 large set of samples.
3001 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3002 @example
3003 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3004 @end example
3005 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3006 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3007
3008 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3009 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3010 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3011 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3012 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3013 be conservative.
3014 @end quotation
3015 @end deffn
3016
3017 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3018 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3019 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3020 @end deffn
3021
3022 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3023 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3024
3025 @example
3026 adapter driver parport
3027 parport port 0x278
3028 parport cable wiggler
3029 @end example
3030 @end deffn
3031
3032 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3033 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3034 @end deffn
3035
3036 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3037 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3038 @end deffn
3039
3040 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3041 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3042 @end deffn
3043
3044 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3045 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3046
3047 @quotation Note
3048 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3049 which are not currently documented here.
3050 @end quotation
3051 @end deffn
3052
3053 @anchor{hla_interface}
3054 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3055 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3056 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3057 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3058
3059 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3060 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3061 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3062 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3063 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3064 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3065
3066 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3067 Currently Not Supported.
3068 @end deffn
3069
3070 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3071 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3072 @end deffn
3073
3074 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3075 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3076 @end deffn
3077
3078 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3079 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3080 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3081
3082 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3083 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3084 ST-LINK server software module}.
3085 @end deffn
3086
3087 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3088 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3089 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3090 @end deffn
3091 @end deffn
3092
3093 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3094 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3095 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3096 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3097 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3098
3099 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3100 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3101 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3102 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3103
3104 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3105 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3106
3107 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3108 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3109 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3110
3111 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3112 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3113 ST-LINK server software module}.
3114
3115 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3116 @end deffn
3117
3118 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3119 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3120 @end deffn
3121
3122 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3123 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3124 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3125
3126 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3127 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3128 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3129 the target's supply voltage.
3130 @example
3131 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3132 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3133 @end example
3134 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3135 @example
3136 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3137 > echo [expr 2*1.2*([lindex $a 4]+256*[lindex $a 5])/([lindex $a 0]+256*[lindex $a 1])]
3138 3.24891518738
3139 @end example
3140 @end deffn
3141 @end deffn
3142
3143 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3144 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3145 @end deffn
3146
3147 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3148 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3149 @end deffn
3150
3151 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3152 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3153 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3154 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3155 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3156
3157 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3158 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3159 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3160 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3161 @end deffn
3162
3163 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3164 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3165 version).
3166 @end deffn
3167 @end deffn
3168
3169 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3170 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3171 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3172 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3173 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3174
3175 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3176
3177 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3178 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3179
3180 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3181 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3182
3183 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3184
3185 @end deffn
3186 @end deffn
3187
3188 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3189 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3190 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3191
3192 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3193 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3194 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3195 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3196 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3197 configuration on exit.
3198
3199 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons.
3200
3201 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3202 pinout.
3203
3204 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3205 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3206 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3207 individually.
3208 @end deffn
3209
3210 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3211 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3212 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3213 @end deffn
3214
3215 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3216 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3217 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3218 @end deffn
3219
3220 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3221 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3222 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3223 @end deffn
3224
3225 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3226 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3227 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3228 @end deffn
3229
3230 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3231 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3232 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3233 @end deffn
3234
3235 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3236 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3237 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3238 @end deffn
3239
3240 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3241 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3242 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3243 @end deffn
3244
3245 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
3246 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3247 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
3248 mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
3249 @end deffn
3250
3251 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3252 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3253 @end deffn
3254
3255 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3256 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3257 @end deffn
3258
3259 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3260 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3261 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3262 @end deffn
3263
3264 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3265 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3266 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3267 list can be found in the
3268 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3269 @end deffn
3270
3271 @end deffn
3272
3273 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3274 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3275 of the one which is most popular.
3276
3277 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3278
3279 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3280 pinout.
3281
3282 @end deffn
3283
3284
3285 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3286 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3287 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3288
3289 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3290 @end deffn
3291
3292
3293 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3294 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3295 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3296
3297 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3298 @end deffn
3299
3300
3301 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3302 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3303 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3304
3305 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3306 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3307 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3308
3309 @itemize @minus
3310 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3311 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3312 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3313 @end itemize
3314 @end deffn
3315
3316 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3317 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3318 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3319 @end deffn
3320 @end deffn
3321
3322
3323 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3324 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3325 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3326 DPI server interface.
3327
3328 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3329 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3330 @end deffn
3331
3332 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3333 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3334 @end deffn
3335 @end deffn
3336
3337
3338 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3339
3340 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3341 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3342
3343 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3344 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3345
3346 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3347 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3348 @example
3349 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3350 @end example
3351 @end deffn
3352
3353 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3354 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3355 @example
3356 buspirate speed normal
3357 @end example
3358 @end deffn
3359
3360 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3361 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3362 @itemize @minus
3363 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3364 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3365 @end itemize
3366 For example:
3367 @example
3368 buspirate mode normal
3369 @end example
3370 @end deffn
3371
3372 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3373 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3374 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3375 For example:
3376 @example
3377 buspirate pullup 0
3378 @end example
3379 @end deffn
3380
3381 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3382 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3383 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3384 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3385 @example
3386 buspirate vreg 0
3387 @end example
3388 @end deffn
3389
3390 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3391 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3392 @end deffn
3393 @example
3394 buspirate led 1
3395 @end example
3396
3397 @end deffn
3398
3399
3400 @section Transport Configuration
3401 @cindex Transport
3402 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3403 and the debug adapter you are using,
3404 several transports may be available to
3405 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3406 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3407 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3408 version of OpenOCD.
3409 @end deffn
3410
3411 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3412 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3413
3414 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3415 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3416 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3417 adapter's driver).
3418
3419 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3420 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3421 supported by the debug adapter.
3422
3423 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3424 transport, if any.
3425 @end deffn
3426
3427 @subsection JTAG Transport
3428 @cindex JTAG
3429 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3430 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3431 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3432 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3433 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3434 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3435
3436 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3437 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3438 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3439 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3440 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3441
3442 @subsection SWD Transport
3443 @cindex SWD
3444 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3445 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3446 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3447 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3448 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3449 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3450 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3451
3452 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3453 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3454 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3455 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3456 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3457
3458 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3459 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3460 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3461 expected to change.
3462 @end deffn
3463
3464 @cindex SWD multi-drop
3465 The newer SWD devices (SW-DP v2 or SWJ-DP v2) support the multi-drop extension
3466 of SWD protocol: two or more devices can be connected to one SWD adapter.
3467 SWD transport works in multi-drop mode if @ref{dap_create,DAP} is configured
3468 with both @code{-dp-id} and @code{-instance-id} parameters regardless how many
3469 DAPs are created.
3470
3471 Not all adapters and adapter drivers support SWD multi-drop. Only the following
3472 adapter drivers are SWD multi-drop capable:
3473 cmsis_dap (use an adapter with CMSIS-DAP version 2.0), ftdi, all bitbang based.
3474
3475 @subsection SPI Transport
3476 @cindex SPI
3477 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3478 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3479 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3480 solution for flash programming.
3481
3482 @anchor{swimtransport}
3483 @subsection SWIM Transport
3484 @cindex SWIM
3485 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3486 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3487 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3488 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3489
3490 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3491
3492 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3493
3494 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3495 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3496 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3497 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3498 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3499
3500 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3501 @section JTAG Speed
3502 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3503 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3504 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3505 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3506 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3507 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3508 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3509 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3510 power management software that may be active.
3511
3512 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3513 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3514 target event handler.
3515 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3516 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3517 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3518 sets up those clocks).
3519 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3520 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3521 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3522 in the target config file.
3523 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3524 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3525 config file instead.
3526 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3527 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3528 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3529
3530 @example
3531 jtag_rclk 3000
3532 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3533 @end example
3534
3535 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3536 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3537 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3538 may not be the fastest solution.
3539
3540 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3541 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3542 which support adaptive clocking.
3543
3544 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3545 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3546 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3547 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3548 than the speed specified.
3549
3550 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3551 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3552 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3553 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3554
3555 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3556 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3557 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3558 JTAG clocking after setup.
3559 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3560 If the interface device can not
3561 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3562 @end deffn
3563
3564 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3565 @cindex adaptive clocking
3566 @cindex RTCK
3567 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3568 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3569 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3570 @example
3571 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3572 jtag_rclk 3000
3573 @end example
3574 @end defun
3575
3576 @node Reset Configuration
3577 @chapter Reset Configuration
3578 @cindex Reset Configuration
3579
3580 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3581 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3582 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3583 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3584 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3585 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3586 Please see the various board files for examples.
3587
3588 @quotation Note
3589 To maintainers and integrators:
3590 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3591 Normally the board configuration file
3592 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3593 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3594
3595 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3596 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3597 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3598 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3599 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3600 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3601 @end quotation
3602
3603 @section Types of Reset
3604
3605 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3606 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3607 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3608
3609 @itemize @bullet
3610 @item
3611 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3612 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3613 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3614 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3615 @item
3616 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3617 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3618 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3619 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3620 @item
3621 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3622 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3623 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3624 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3625 @item
3626 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3627 several other types of reset.
3628 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3629 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3630 There may be individual module resets.
3631 @end itemize
3632
3633 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3634 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3635 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3636 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3637 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3638 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3639 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3640 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3641 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3642
3643 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3644 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3645
3646 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3647 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3648 common issues are:
3649
3650 @itemize @bullet
3651
3652 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3653 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3654 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3655 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3656 when either of those signals is not connected.
3657 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3658 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3659 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3660 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3661
3662 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3663 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3664 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3665 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3666
3667 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3668 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3669 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3670 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3671 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3672 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3673 hardware debouncing.
3674 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3675 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3676
3677 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3678 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3679 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3680 to use push/pull output drivers.
3681 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3682 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3683 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3684 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3685
3686 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3687 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3688 issues (not limited to errata).
3689 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3690 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3691 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3692 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3693 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3694 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3695 @end itemize
3696
3697 There can also be other issues.
3698 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3699 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3700 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3701 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3702 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3703 Agreement (NDA).
3704
3705 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3706 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3707 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3708
3709 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3710 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3711
3712 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3713
3714 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3715 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3716 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3717 allowing it to be deasserted.
3718 @end deffn
3719
3720 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3721 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3722 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3723 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3724 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3725 @end deffn
3726
3727 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3728 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3729 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3730 allowing it to be deasserted.
3731 @end deffn
3732
3733 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3734 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3735 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3736 @end deffn
3737
3738 @anchor{reset_config}
3739 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3740 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3741 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3742 configuration scripts.
3743
3744 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3745 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3746 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3747 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3748 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3749 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3750 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3751 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3752
3753 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3754 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3755 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3756 -- may be specified at a time.
3757 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3758 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3759 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3760 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3761 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3762
3763 @itemize
3764 @item
3765 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3766 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3767 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3768 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3769 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3770
3771 @quotation Tip
3772 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3773 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3774 @end quotation
3775
3776 @item
3777 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3778 signal implementations.
3779 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3780 indicating everything behaves normally.
3781 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3782 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3783 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3784 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3785 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3786 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3787 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3788
3789 @item
3790 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3791 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3792 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3793 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3794 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3795 while SRST is asserted.
3796 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3797 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3798
3799 @item
3800 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3801 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3802 is required to use this option.
3803 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3804 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3805 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3806 be asserted before any target connection.
3807 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3808 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3809 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3810 @end itemize
3811
3812 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3813 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3814 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3815 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3816 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3817
3818 @itemize
3819 @item
3820 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3821 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3822 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3823 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3824
3825 @item
3826 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3827 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3828 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3829 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3830 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3831 @end itemize
3832 @end deffn
3833
3834 @section Custom Reset Handling
3835 @cindex events
3836
3837 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3838 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3839 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3840 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3841 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3842 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3843
3844 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3845 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3846 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3847 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3848 want to reset everything at once.
3849
3850 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3851 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3852 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3853 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3854 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3855 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3856 needs special attention.
3857
3858 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3859 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3860 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3861 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3862 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3863 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3864 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3865 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3866 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3867
3868 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3869 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3870 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3871 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3872 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3873
3874 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
3875 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3876 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3877 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3878 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3879 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3880 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3881 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3882 or potentially some other value.
3883
3884 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3885 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3886 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3887 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3888 (or their associated targets)
3889 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3890
3891 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3892 they return.
3893 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3894 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3895 @end deffn
3896
3897 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
3898 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3899 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3900 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3901 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3902 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3903 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3904 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3905 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3906 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3907 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3908 @end deffn
3909
3910 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
3911 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3912 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3913 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3914 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3915 @end deffn
3916
3917
3918 @node TAP Declaration
3919 @chapter TAP Declaration
3920 @cindex TAP declaration
3921 @cindex TAP configuration
3922
3923 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3924 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3925
3926 @itemize @bullet
3927 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3928 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3929 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3930 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3931 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3932 start running that code.
3933 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3934 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3935 and missing connections.
3936 @end itemize
3937
3938 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3939 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3940 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3941 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3942 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3943
3944 @section Scan Chains
3945 @cindex scan chain
3946
3947 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3948 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3949 They also need to be added to
3950 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3951 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3952 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3953 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3954 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3955 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3956 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3957 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3958
3959 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3960 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3961 command, presented in the next chapter.
3962 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3963 debugging targets.)
3964 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3965
3966 @verbatim
3967 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3968 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3969 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3970 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3971 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3972 @end verbatim
3973
3974 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3975 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3976 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3977 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3978 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3979 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3980 until they are told to do so.
3981
3982 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3983 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3984 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3985 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3986
3987 @example
3988 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3989 @end example
3990
3991 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3992 by a given chip.
3993 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3994 and so forth.
3995 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3996 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3997 both inside a single chip and between them.
3998 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3999
4000 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
4001 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
4002 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
4003 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
4004 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
4005 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
4006 includes commands something like this:
4007
4008 @example
4009 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
4010 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
4011 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
4012 @end example
4013
4014 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
4015 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
4016 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
4017
4018 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4019 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4020 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4021 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4022 @example
4023 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4024 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4025 @}
4026 @end example
4027 @end deffn
4028
4029 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4030 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4031 and their status.
4032 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4033 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4034 but systems with a JTAG router can
4035 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4036 @end deffn
4037
4038 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4039 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4040
4041 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4042 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4043
4044 @section TAP Names
4045 @cindex dotted name
4046
4047 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4048 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4049 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4050 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4051 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4052 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4053 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4054 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4055
4056 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4057 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4058 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4059
4060 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4061
4062 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4063 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4064 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4065
4066 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4067 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4068 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4069 overridable.
4070
4071 @cindex TAP naming convention
4072 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4073 and should follow this convention:
4074
4075 @itemize @bullet
4076 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4077 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4078 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4079 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4080 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4081 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4082 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4083 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4084 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4085 with a single TAP;
4086 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4087 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4088 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4089 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4090 @end itemize
4091
4092 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4093
4094 @itemize @bullet
4095 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4096 @*The length in bits of the
4097 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4098 @end itemize
4099
4100 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4101
4102 @itemize @bullet
4103 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4104 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4105 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4106 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4107 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4108 (the TAP is linked in).
4109 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4110 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4111 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4112 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4113 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4114 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4115 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4116 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4117 values that were found but not included in the list.
4118
4119 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4120 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4121 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4122 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4123 hardware to find these values.
4124 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4125 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4126 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4127 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4128 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4129 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4130 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4131 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4132 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4133 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4134 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4135 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4136 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4137 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4138 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4139 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4140 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4141 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4142 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4143 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4144 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4145 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4146 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4147 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4148 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4149 @end itemize
4150 @end deffn
4151
4152 @section Other TAP commands
4153
4154 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4155 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4156 @end deffn
4157
4158 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4159 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4160 At this writing this TAP attribute
4161 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4162 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4163 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4164 See the next section for information about the available events.
4165
4166 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4167 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4168 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4169 @end deffn
4170
4171 @section TAP Events
4172 @cindex events
4173 @cindex TAP events
4174
4175 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4176 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4177 The other applies to debugger targets,
4178 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4179
4180 The TAP events currently defined are:
4181
4182 @itemize @bullet
4183 @item @b{post-reset}
4184 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4185 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4186 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4187 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4188 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4189
4190 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4191 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4192 of any particular target.
4193 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4194 @item @b{setup}
4195 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4196 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4197 @item @b{tap-disable}
4198 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4199 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4200 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4201 @item @b{tap-enable}
4202 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4203 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4204 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4205 @end itemize
4206
4207 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4208 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4209 contents to be accurate), you might:
4210
4211 @example
4212 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4213 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4214 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4215 @}
4216 @end example
4217
4218
4219 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4220 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4221 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4222 @cindex jrc
4223
4224 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4225 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4226 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4227 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4228 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4229
4230 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4231 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4232 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4233 be visible.
4234 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4235 ignores, such as:
4236
4237 @itemize
4238 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4239 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4240 TAPs receive new instructions.
4241 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4242 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4243 @end itemize
4244
4245 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4246 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4247 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4248 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4249
4250 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4251 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4252
4253 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4254 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4255 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4256 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4257 should define TAP event handlers using
4258 code that looks something like this:
4259
4260 @example
4261 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4262 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4263 @}
4264 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4265 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4266 @}
4267 @end example
4268
4269 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4270
4271 @example
4272 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4273 @end example
4274
4275 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4276 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4277 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4278 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4279
4280 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4281 If necessary, disables the tap
4282 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4283 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4284 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4285 and "0" if it is disabled.
4286 @end deffn
4287
4288 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4289 If necessary, enables the tap
4290 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4291 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4292 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4293 and "0" if it is disabled.
4294 @end deffn
4295
4296 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4297 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4298 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4299 and "0" if it is disabled.
4300
4301 @quotation Note
4302 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4303 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4304 @end quotation
4305 @end deffn
4306
4307 @anchor{autoprobing}
4308 @section Autoprobing
4309 @cindex autoprobe
4310 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4311
4312 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4313 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4314 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4315 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4316
4317 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4318 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4319 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4320 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4321 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4322 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4323 right when they come out of reset).
4324
4325 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4326
4327 @example
4328 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4329 reset_config trst_and_srst
4330 jtag_rclk 8
4331 @end example
4332
4333 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4334 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4335
4336 @enumerate
4337 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4338 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4339 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4340 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4341 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4342 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4343 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4344 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4345 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4346 that is discovered.
4347 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4348 register, it will report it.
4349 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4350 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4351 @end enumerate
4352
4353 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4354 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4355 that's a bit more complex:
4356
4357 @example
4358 clock speed 8 kHz
4359 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4360 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4361 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4362 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4363 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4364 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4365 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4366 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4367 @end example
4368
4369 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4370 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4371 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4372 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4373 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4374 and so forth.
4375
4376 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4377 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4378 @cindex DAP declaration
4379
4380 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4381 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4382 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4383 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4384 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4385
4386 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4387
4388 @anchor{dap_create}
4389 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4390 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4391 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4392 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4393 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4394
4395 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4396
4397 @itemize @bullet
4398 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4399 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4400 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4401 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4402 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4403
4404 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4405 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4406 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4407 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4408 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4409 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4410
4411 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4412 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4413 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4414 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4415 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4416 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4417 @end itemize
4418 @end deffn
4419
4420 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4421 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4422 for TCL scripting.
4423 @end deffn
4424
4425 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4426 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4427 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4428 @end deffn
4429
4430 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4431 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4432 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4433 initialization, too.
4434 @end deffn
4435
4436 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4437
4438 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4439 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4440 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4441 @end deffn
4442
4443 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4444 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4445 @end deffn
4446
4447 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4448 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4449 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4450 or set a new value @var{value}.
4451 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4452 @end deffn
4453
4454 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4455 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4456 @end deffn
4457
4458 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4459 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4460 value @var{value}.
4461
4462 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4463 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4464 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4465
4466 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4467 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4468 @end deffn
4469
4470 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4471 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4472 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4473 @end deffn
4474
4475 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4476 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4477 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4478 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4479 @end deffn
4480
4481 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4482 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4483
4484 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4485 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4486 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4487 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4488 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4489 for details.
4490
4491 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4492 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4493 the pattern:
4494 @example
4495 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4496 @end example
4497
4498 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4499 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4500 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4501 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4502 @example
4503 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4504 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4505 @end example
4506
4507 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4508 @example
4509 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4510 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4511 @end example
4512
4513 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4514 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4515
4516 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4517 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4518 example with a proper dap name:
4519 @example
4520 xxx.dap apcsw default
4521 @end example
4522 @end deffn
4523
4524 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4525 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4526 Disabled by default
4527 @end deffn
4528
4529
4530 @node CPU Configuration
4531 @chapter CPU Configuration
4532 @cindex GDB target
4533
4534 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4535 You can also access these targets without GDB
4536 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4537 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4538 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4539 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4540
4541 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4542 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4543
4544 @section Target List
4545 @cindex target, current
4546 @cindex target, list
4547
4548 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4549 where each member has a name.
4550 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4551 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4552 (plural!) command.
4553 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4554 look like with more than one:
4555 @verbatim
4556 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4557 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4558 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4559 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4560 @end verbatim
4561
4562 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4563 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4564 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4565 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4566 space seen by that current target.
4567 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4568 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4569 are examples; and there are many more.
4570
4571 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4572
4573 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4574 Returns the name of the current target.
4575 @end deffn
4576
4577 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4578 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4579 @example
4580 foreach t [target names] @{
4581 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4582 @}
4583 @end example
4584 @end deffn
4585
4586 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4587 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4588
4589 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4590 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4591 command names are singular.}
4592
4593 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4594 targets in a user friendly form.
4595
4596 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4597 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4598 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4599 @end deffn
4600
4601 @section Target CPU Types
4602 @cindex target type
4603 @cindex CPU type
4604
4605 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4606 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4607 when calling @command{target create}.
4608 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4609 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4610 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4611 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4612 what core-specific commands may be available
4613 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4614 and more.
4615
4616 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4617 since there's a command to list them.
4618
4619 @anchor{targettypes}
4620 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4621 Lists all supported target types.
4622 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4623
4624 @itemize @bullet
4625 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4626 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4627 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4628 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4629 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4630 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4631 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4632 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4633 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4634 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4635 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4636 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4637 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4638 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4639 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4640 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4641 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4642 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4643 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4644 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4645 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4646 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4647 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4648 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4649 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4650 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4651 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4652 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4653 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4654 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4655 support for new CPUs.
4656 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4657 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4658 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4659 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4660 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4661 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4662 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4663 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4664 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4665 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4666 @itemize @minus
4667 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4668 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4669 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4670 @end itemize
4671 And two debug interfaces cores:
4672 @itemize @minus
4673 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4674 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4675 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4676 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4677 @end itemize
4678 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4679 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4680 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4681 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4682 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4683 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4684 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4685 @end itemize
4686 @end deffn
4687
4688 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4689 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4690 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4691 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4692 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4693 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4694 reflect design generations;
4695 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4696 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4697
4698 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4699 @section Target Configuration
4700
4701 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4702 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4703 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4704 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4705 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4706
4707 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4708 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4709 optional parts.
4710 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4711 command, created as part of target creation.
4712
4713 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4714 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4715 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4716 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4717 to be much more board-specific.
4718 The key steps you use might look something like this
4719
4720 @example
4721 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4722 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4723 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4724 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4725 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4726 @end example
4727
4728 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4729 on-chip SRAM.
4730 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4731 writes to target memory;
4732 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4733 GDB memory checksumming;
4734 and more.
4735
4736 @quotation Warning
4737 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4738 inaccessible when application code
4739 (such as an operating system)
4740 enables or disables the MMU.
4741 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4742 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4743 easy access to other addresses needed.
4744 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4745 @end quotation
4746
4747 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4748 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4749 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4750 controllers.
4751 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4752 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4753 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4754
4755 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4756 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4757 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4758 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4759 purposes including additional configuration.
4760
4761 @itemize @bullet
4762 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4763 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4764 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4765 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4766
4767 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4768 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4769 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4770 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4771 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4772 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4773 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4774
4775 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4776 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4777 @end itemize
4778 @end deffn
4779
4780 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4781 The options accepted by this command may also be
4782 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4783 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4784 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4785
4786 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4787 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4788 and changing its endianness.
4789
4790 @itemize @bullet
4791
4792 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4793 used to access this target.
4794
4795 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4796 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4797 create and manage DAP instances.
4798
4799 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4800 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4801
4802 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4803 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4804 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4805 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4806 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4807 same event name assigns only one handler.
4808
4809 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4810 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4811
4812 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4813 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4814 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4815 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4816 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4817 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4818 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4819
4820 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4821 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4822 or virtual address is being used.
4823
4824 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4825 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4826
4827 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4828 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4829 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4830 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4831 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4832
4833 @anchor{rtostype}
4834 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4835 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4836 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4837 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4838 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
4839 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4840
4841 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4842 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4843 access the target for debugging.
4844
4845 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4846 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4847 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4848 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4849
4850 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4851 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4852 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4853 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4854 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4855
4856 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4857 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4858 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4859 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4860 command @command{gdb_port}.
4861 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4862
4863 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4864 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4865 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4866 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4867 @end itemize
4868 @end deffn
4869
4870 @section Other $target_name Commands
4871 @cindex object command
4872
4873 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4874 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4875
4876 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4877 Once a button is created a button
4878 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4879 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4880 configure it like this:
4881
4882 @example
4883 # Create
4884 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4885 # Modify
4886 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4887 # Query
4888 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4889 # Report
4890 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4891 @end example
4892
4893 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4894 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4895
4896 @example
4897 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4898 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4899 @end example
4900
4901 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4902
4903 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4904 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
4905 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
4906 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
4907 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4908 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4909 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4910 They are not otherwise documented here.
4911 @end deffn
4912
4913 @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4914 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4915 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4916 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, words
4917 or double-words; while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4918 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4919 the target side uses raw memory.
4920
4921 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4922 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4923 The script orientation comes from working with data
4924 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4925 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4926 and neither store nor return those values.
4927
4928 @itemize
4929 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4930 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32/64 - indicating the memory access size
4931 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4932 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4933 @end itemize
4934 @end deffn
4935
4936 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
4937 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4938 @command{$target_name configure}
4939 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4940 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4941 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4942 There are a few special cases:
4943
4944 @itemize @bullet
4945 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4946 event named @var{event_name}.
4947 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4948 two parameters.
4949 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4950 This is a special case because this is set using
4951 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4952 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4953 @end itemize
4954
4955 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4956 all the targets you might use something like this:
4957
4958 @example
4959 foreach name [target names] @{
4960 set y [$name cget -endian]
4961 set z [$name cget -type]
4962 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4963 $x $name $y $z]
4964 @}
4965 @end example
4966 @end deffn
4967
4968 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4969 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
4970 Displays the current target state:
4971 @code{debug-running},
4972 @code{halted},
4973 @code{reset},
4974 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4975 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4976 @end deffn
4977
4978 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
4979 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4980 currently associated with this target.
4981 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4982 @end deffn
4983
4984 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4985 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4986 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4987 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4988 @end deffn
4989
4990 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4991 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4992 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4993 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4994 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4995 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4996 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4997 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4998 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4999 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5000 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5001 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5002 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5003 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
5004 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
5005 @end deffn
5006
5007 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
5008 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
5009 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
5010 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
5011 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5012 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
5013 at the specified address @var{addr}.
5014 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5015 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5016 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5017 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5018 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
5019 @end deffn
5020
5021 @anchor{targetevents}
5022 @section Target Events
5023 @cindex target events
5024 @cindex events
5025 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5026 For example:
5027 @itemize @bullet
5028 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5029 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5030 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5031 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5032 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5033 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5034 to set up system clocks or
5035 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5036 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5037 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5038 @end itemize
5039
5040 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5041 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5042 @command{target create ... -event}.
5043
5044 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5045 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5046 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5047
5048 @example
5049 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5050 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5051 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5052 @}
5053 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5054 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5055 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5056 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5057 @}
5058 @end example
5059
5060 The following target events are defined:
5061
5062 @itemize @bullet
5063 @item @b{debug-halted}
5064 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5065 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5066 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5067 @item @b{early-halted}
5068 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5069 @item @b{examine-start}
5070 @* Before target examine is called.
5071 @item @b{examine-end}
5072 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5073 @item @b{examine-fail}
5074 @* After target examine fails.
5075 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5076 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5077 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5078 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5079 connect GDB to running target.
5080 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5081 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5082 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5083 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5084 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5085 is in RAM or read only memory.
5086 Default is @code{halt}
5087 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5088 @* When GDB disconnects
5089 @item @b{gdb-end}
5090 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5091 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5092 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5093 @code{reset init})
5094 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5095 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5096 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5097 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5098 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5099 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5100 @item @b{gdb-start}
5101 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5102 @item @b{halted}
5103 @* The target has halted
5104 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5105 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5106 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5107 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5108 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5109 @item @b{reset-assert}
5110 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5111 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5112 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5113 it instead of asserting SRST.
5114 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5115 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5116 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5117 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5118 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5119 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5120 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5121 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5122 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5123 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5124 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5125 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5126 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5127 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5128 released on the scan chain.
5129 @item @b{reset-end}
5130 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5131 @item @b{reset-init}
5132 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5133 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5134
5135 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5136 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5137 multiplexing, and so on.
5138 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5139 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5140 @item @b{reset-start}
5141 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5142 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5143
5144 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5145 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5146 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5147 @item @b{resume-start}
5148 @* Before any target is resumed
5149 @item @b{resume-end}
5150 @* After all targets have resumed
5151 @item @b{resumed}
5152 @* Target has resumed
5153 @item @b{step-start}
5154 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5155 @item @b{step-end}
5156 @* After single-step has completed
5157 @item @b{trace-config}
5158 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5159 @end itemize
5160
5161 @quotation Note
5162 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5163 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5164 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5165 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5166 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5167 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5168 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5169 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5170 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5171 check if the core has changed status.
5172 @end quotation
5173
5174 @node Flash Commands
5175 @chapter Flash Commands
5176
5177 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5178 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5179 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5180 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5181 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5182 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5183 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5184 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5185 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5186
5187 Flash Steps:
5188 @enumerate
5189 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5190 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5191 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5192 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5193 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5194 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5195 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5196 @item GDB Flashing
5197 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5198 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5199 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5200 @end enumerate
5201
5202 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5203 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5204 so that it can't boot.
5205 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5206 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5207
5208 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5209 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5210 @cindex flash configuration
5211
5212 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5213 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5214 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5215 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5216 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5217 see the driver-specific documentation.
5218
5219 @itemize @bullet
5220 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5221 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5222 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5223 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5224 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5225 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5226 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5227 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5228 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5229 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5230 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5231 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5232 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5233 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5234 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5235 commands to the flash controller.
5236 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5237 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5238 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5239 for more information.
5240 @end itemize
5241 @quotation Note
5242 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5243 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5244 @end quotation
5245 @end deffn
5246
5247 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5248 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5249 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5250 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5251 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5252 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5253 @end deffn
5254
5255 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5256 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5257 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5258 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5259 @end deffn
5260
5261 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5262 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5263 depends on the flash type.
5264 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5265 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5266 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5267 but most don't bother.
5268 @end deffn
5269
5270 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5271
5272 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5273 begins.
5274
5275 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5276 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5277 until the programming session is finished.
5278
5279 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5280 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5281
5282 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5283
5284 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5285 @cindex flash erasing
5286 @cindex flash reading
5287 @cindex flash writing
5288 @cindex flash programming
5289 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5290
5291 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5292 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5293 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5294 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5295 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5296
5297 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5298 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5299 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5300 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5301 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5302
5303 @quotation Note
5304 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5305 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5306 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5307 back to a flash bank.
5308 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5309 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5310 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5311 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5312 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5313 @end quotation
5314
5315 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5316 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5317 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5318 disabled first.
5319 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5320 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5321 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5322
5323 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5324 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5325 up to and including @var{last}.
5326 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5327 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5328 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5329 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5330 @end deffn
5331
5332 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5333 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5334 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5335 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5336 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5337 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5338 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5339 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5340 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5341 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5342 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5343 before erase starts.
5344 @end deffn
5345
5346 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5347 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5348 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5349 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5350 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5351 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5352 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5353 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5354 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5355 before issuing this command.
5356 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5357 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5358 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5359 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5360 @end deffn
5361 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5362
5363 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5364 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5365 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5366 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5367 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5368 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5369 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5370 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5371 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5372 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5373 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5374 @end deffn
5375
5376 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5377 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5378 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5379 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5380 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5381 @end deffn
5382
5383 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5384 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5385 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5386 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5387 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5388 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5389 @end deffn
5390
5391 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5392 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5393 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5394 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5395 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5396 @end deffn
5397
5398 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5399 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5400 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5401 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5402 to the base address for each section in the image.
5403 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5404 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5405 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5406 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5407 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5408 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5409 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5410 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5411 each image section.
5412
5413 @quotation Warning
5414 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5415 data you want to preserve.
5416 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5417 sections might be erased with no notice.
5418 @itemize
5419 @item
5420 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5421 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5422 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5423 @item
5424 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5425 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5426 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5427 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5428 @end itemize
5429 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5430 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5431 @end quotation
5432
5433 @end deffn
5434
5435 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5436 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5437 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5438 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5439 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5440 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5441 ordinary memory reads.
5442 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5443 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5444 check for successful programming.
5445 @end deffn
5446
5447 @section Other Flash commands
5448 @cindex flash protection
5449
5450 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5451 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5452 and display that status.
5453 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5454 @end deffn
5455
5456 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5457 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5458 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5459
5460 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5461 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5462 and possibly stale information.
5463 @end deffn
5464
5465 @anchor{flashprotect}
5466 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5467 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5468 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5469 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5470 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5471 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5472 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5473 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5474 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5475 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5476 @end deffn
5477
5478 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5479 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5480 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5481 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5482 @end deffn
5483
5484 @anchor{program}
5485 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5486 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5487 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5488 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5489 @end deffn
5490
5491 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5492 @section Flash Driver List
5493 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5494 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5495 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5496
5497 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5498 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5499 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5500
5501 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5502
5503 @itemize
5504 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5505 @end itemize
5506
5507 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5508 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5509 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5510 @example
5511 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5512 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5513 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5514 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5515 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5516 @end example
5517 @end deffn
5518
5519 @subsection External Flash
5520
5521 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5522 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5523 @cindex CFI
5524 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5525 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5526 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5527 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5528 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5529 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5530 configure a bus and its timings), or
5531 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5532 on the flash chip.
5533 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5534 speed up operation.
5535
5536 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5537
5538 @itemize
5539 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5540 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5541 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5542 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5543 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5544 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5545 @end itemize
5546
5547 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5548 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5549
5550 @example
5551 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5552 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5553 @end example
5554
5555 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5556 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5557 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5558
5559 @example
5560 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5561 @end example
5562
5563 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5564 @end deffn
5565
5566 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5567 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5568 @cindex SPI
5569 @cindex jtagspi
5570 @cindex bscan_spi
5571 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5572 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5573 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5574 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5575 accessed through JTAG.
5576
5577 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5578 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5579 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5580 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5581 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5582 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5583
5584 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5585 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5586 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5587 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5588 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5589 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5590 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5591 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5592
5593 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5594 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5595 command, see below.
5596
5597 @itemize
5598 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5599 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5600 @var{USER1} instruction.
5601 @end itemize
5602
5603 @example
5604 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5605 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5606 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5607 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5608 @end example
5609
5610 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5611 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5612 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5613 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5614 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5615 @example
5616 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5617 @end example
5618 @end deffn
5619
5620 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5621 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5622 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5623 @example
5624 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5625 @end example
5626 @end deffn
5627
5628 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5629 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5630 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5631 @end deffn
5632 @end deffn
5633
5634 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5635 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5636 @cindex xcf
5637 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5638 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5639 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5640 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5641 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5642
5643 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5644 command accepts additional parameters:
5645 @itemize
5646 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5647 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5648 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5649 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5650 in master mode.
5651 @end itemize
5652 @example
5653 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5654 @end example
5655 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5656 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5657 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5658 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5659 dedicated sector.
5660 @end deffn
5661
5662 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5663 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5664 button.
5665 @example
5666 xcf configure 0
5667 @end example
5668 @end deffn
5669
5670 Additional driver notes:
5671 @itemize
5672 @item Only single revision supported.
5673 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5674 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5675 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5676 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5677 @end itemize
5678 @end deffn
5679
5680 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5681 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5682 @cindex SPIFI
5683 @cindex lpcspifi
5684 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5685 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5686 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5687
5688 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5689 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5690 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5691 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5692 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5693
5694 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5695 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5696 are configured by the driver.
5697
5698 @example
5699 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5700 @end example
5701
5702 @end deffn
5703
5704 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5705 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5706 @cindex SMI
5707 @cindex stmsmi
5708 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5709 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5710 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5711 SPI flash devices.
5712 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5713 flash devices can be connected.
5714
5715 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5716 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5717 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5718 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5719 the flash content.
5720
5721 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5722 to identify the memory bank.
5723 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5724 flash size, are detected automatically.
5725
5726 @example
5727 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5728 @end example
5729
5730 @end deffn
5731
5732 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5733 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5734 @cindex QuadSPI
5735 @cindex OctoSPI
5736 @cindex stmqspi
5737 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5738 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5739 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5740 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5741 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5742 mode is not.
5743
5744 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5745 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5746 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5747 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5748
5749 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5750 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5751 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5752
5753 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5754 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5755 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5756 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5757 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5758 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5759
5760 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5761 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
5762 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5763 should be avoided.
5764
5765 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5766 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5767 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5768 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5769 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5770 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5771
5772 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5773 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5774 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5775 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5776 persist across openocd invocations.
5777
5778 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5779 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5780 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5781 required (see 'set' command).
5782
5783 @example
5784 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5785 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5786 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5787 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5788 @end example
5789
5790 There are three specific commands
5791 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5792 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5793 chip specific write protection engaged.
5794 @end deffn
5795
5796 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5797 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5798 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5799 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5800 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5801 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5802
5803 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5804 which don't support an id command.
5805
5806 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5807 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5808 @end deffn
5809
5810 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5811 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5812 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5813 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5814 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5815
5816 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5817 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5818 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5819 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5820
5821 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5822
5823 To check basic communication settings, issue
5824 @example
5825 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5826 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5827 @end example
5828 for single flash mode or
5829 @example
5830 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5831 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5832 @end example
5833 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5834
5835 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5836 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5837 need a dummy address, e.g.
5838 @example
5839 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5840 @end example
5841 should return the status register contents.
5842
5843 @end deffn
5844
5845 @end deffn
5846
5847 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
5848 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5849 Microcontroller platform.
5850
5851 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5852 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5853
5854 @example
5855 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5856 @end example
5857
5858 @end deffn
5859
5860 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
5861 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5862 @cindex ath79
5863 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5864 chip selects.
5865 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5866 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5867 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5868 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5869 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5870 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5871
5872 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5873 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5874 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5875 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5876 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5877 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5878 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5879 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5880 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5881 with the default CS0.
5882 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5883 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5884 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5885
5886 @example
5887 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5888
5889 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5890 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5891 # distinguish the banks.
5892 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5893 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5894 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5895 @end example
5896
5897 @end deffn
5898
5899 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
5900 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5901 @cindex fespi
5902
5903 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5904
5905 @example
5906 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5907 @end example
5908 @end deffn
5909
5910 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5911
5912 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
5913 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5914 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5915 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5916 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5917 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5918
5919 @example
5920 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5921 @end example
5922 @end deffn
5923
5924 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
5925 @cindex ambiqmicro
5926 @cindex apollo
5927 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5928 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5929 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5930 with the target using SWD.
5931
5932 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5933 the device class of the MCU.
5934 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5935 to set up the flash banks.
5936 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5937 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5938
5939 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5940 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5941 and the second bank starts after the first.
5942
5943 @example
5944 # Flash bank 0
5945 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5946 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5947 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5948 $_TARGETNAME
5949 @end example
5950
5951 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5952 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5953 are available to the user.
5954
5955 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5956
5957 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5958 Erase entire bank.
5959 @end deffn
5960 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5961 Erase device pages.
5962 @end deffn
5963 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5964 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5965 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5966 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5967 the flash.
5968 @end deffn
5969 @end deffn
5970
5971 @anchor{at91samd}
5972 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
5973 @cindex at91samd
5974 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5975 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5976
5977 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5978
5979 The devices have one flash bank:
5980
5981 @example
5982 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5983 @end example
5984
5985 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
5986 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5987 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5988 processor to be halted.
5989 @end deffn
5990
5991 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
5992 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5993 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5994 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5995 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5996 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5997
5998 @example
5999 at91samd set-security enable
6000 @end example
6001 @end deffn
6002
6003 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
6004 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
6005 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
6006 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
6007 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
6008 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
6009 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
6010 in order to disable this feature.
6011
6012 @example
6013 at91samd eeprom
6014 at91samd eeprom 1024
6015 @end example
6016 @end deffn
6017
6018 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
6019 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
6020 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6021 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
6022 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
6023 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6024
6025 @example
6026 at91samd bootloader
6027 at91samd bootloader 16384
6028 @end example
6029 @end deffn
6030
6031 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6032 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6033 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6034 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6035 @end deffn
6036
6037 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6038 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6039 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6040 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6041 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6042 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6043 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6044 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6045
6046 @example
6047 # Read user row
6048 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6049 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6050 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6051 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6052 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6053 # byte unchanged
6054 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6055 @end example
6056 @end deffn
6057
6058 @end deffn
6059
6060 @anchor{at91sam3}
6061 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6062 @cindex at91sam3
6063 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6064 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6065 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6066 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6067 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6068 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6069 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6070 chips are confirmed.}
6071
6072 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6073 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6074 the following fixed locations:
6075
6076 @example
6077 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6078 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6079 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6080 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6081 @end example
6082
6083 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6084 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6085 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6086
6087 @itemize
6088 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6089 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6090 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6091 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6092 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6093 @end itemize
6094
6095 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6096
6097 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6098 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6099 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6100 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6101 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6102 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6103 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6104
6105 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6106 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6107 @end deffn
6108
6109 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6110 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6111 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6112 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6113 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6114 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6115 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6116 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6117 @end deffn
6118
6119 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6120 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6121 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6122 @end deffn
6123 @end deffn
6124
6125 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6126 @cindex at91sam4
6127 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6128 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6129 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6130 @end deffn
6131
6132 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6133 @cindex at91sam4l
6134 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6135 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6136 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6137
6138 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6139 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6140 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6141 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6142 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6143 @end deffn
6144 @end deffn
6145
6146 @anchor{atsame5}
6147 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6148 @cindex atsame5
6149 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6150 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6151 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6152
6153 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6154 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6155 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6156
6157 @example
6158 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6159 @end example
6160
6161 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6162 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6163 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6164 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6165 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6166 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6167
6168 @example
6169 atsame5 bootloader
6170 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6171 @end example
6172 @end deffn
6173
6174 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6175 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6176 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6177 processor to be halted.
6178 @end deffn
6179
6180 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6181 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6182 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6183 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6184 @end deffn
6185
6186 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6187 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6188 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6189 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6190 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6191 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6192 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6193 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6194
6195 @example
6196 # Read
6197 >atsame5 userpage
6198 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6199 # Write
6200 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6201 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6202 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6203 # bytes)
6204 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6205 @end example
6206 @end deffn
6207
6208 @end deffn
6209
6210 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6211 @cindex atsamv
6212 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6213 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6214 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6215
6216 @example
6217 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsamv 0x00400000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6218 @end example
6219
6220 @deffn {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} [@option{show} [@option{all}|number]]
6221 @deffnx {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} (@option{clr}|@option{set}) number
6222 With no parameters, @option{show} or @option{show all},
6223 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6224 With @option{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6225
6226 With @option{set} @var{number} or @option{clear} @var{number},
6227 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6228 @end deffn
6229
6230 @end deffn
6231
6232 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6233 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6234 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6235 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6236 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6237
6238 @example
6239 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6240 @end example
6241
6242 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6243 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6244
6245 @itemize
6246 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6247 @item @var{banks}
6248 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6249 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6250 @item @var{pages_size}
6251 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6252 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6253 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6254 @end itemize
6255
6256 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6257 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6258 will be autoconfigured.
6259 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6260
6261 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6262 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6263 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6264 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6265 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6266
6267 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6268 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6269 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6270 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6271 are not truly general purpose).
6272 @quotation Note
6273 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6274 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6275 @end quotation
6276 @end deffn
6277 @end deffn
6278
6279 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6280 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6281 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6282 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6283 @end deffn
6284
6285 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6286 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6287 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6288 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6289
6290 @example
6291 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6292 @end example
6293
6294 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6295 each single sector one by one.
6296
6297 @example
6298 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6299 @end example
6300
6301 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6302 @end deffn
6303
6304 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6305 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6306 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6307 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6308 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6309 starts at address 0.
6310
6311 @example
6312 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6313 @end example
6314 @end deffn
6315
6316 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6317 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6318 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6319 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6320 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6321 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6322 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6323 and programming the serial flash.
6324
6325 @example
6326 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6327 @end example
6328 @end deffn
6329
6330 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6331 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6332 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6333 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6334 autoconfigures itself.
6335 @example
6336 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6337 @end example
6338 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6339 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6340 this via the following command:
6341 @example
6342 efm32 debuglock num
6343 @end example
6344 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6345 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6346 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6347 supported.}
6348 @end deffn
6349
6350 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6351 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6352 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6353 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6354 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6355 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6356
6357 @example
6358 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6359 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6360 @end example
6361
6362 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6363 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6364 @end deffn
6365
6366 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6367 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6368 is an uncommon operation.}
6369 @end deffn
6370 @end deffn
6371
6372 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6373 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6374 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6375 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6376 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6377 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6378 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6379
6380 @example
6381 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6382 @end example
6383 @end deffn
6384
6385 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6386 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6387 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6388 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6389 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6390 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6391 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6392 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6393 characters) ignored.
6394
6395 @example
6396 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6397 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6398 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6399 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6400 @end example
6401 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6402 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6403 @end deffn
6404
6405 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6406 @cindex kinetis
6407 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6408 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6409 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6410 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6411 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6412 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6413
6414 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6415 @itemize
6416 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6417 @end itemize
6418
6419 @example
6420 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6421 @end example
6422
6423 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6424 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6425 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6426 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6427 @end deffn
6428
6429 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6430 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6431 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6432 set by 'flash protect' command.
6433 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6434 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6435 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6436 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6437 with the rest of a flash image.
6438 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6439 @end deffn
6440
6441 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6442 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6443 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6444 @end deffn
6445
6446 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6447 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6448 and examine-fail event.
6449 @end deffn
6450
6451 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6452 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6453 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6454 @end deffn
6455
6456 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6457 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6458 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6459 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6460 command completes.
6461 @end deffn
6462
6463 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6464 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6465 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6466 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6467 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6468
6469 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6470 Program Partition command.
6471
6472 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6473 Reset the device after partition setting.
6474
6475 Show partition size:
6476 @example
6477 kinetis nvm_partition info
6478 @end example
6479
6480 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6481 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6482 @example
6483 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6484 @end example
6485
6486 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6487 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6488 @example
6489 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6490 @end example
6491 @end deffn
6492
6493 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6494 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6495 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6496 @end deffn
6497
6498 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6499 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6500 Command disables watchdog timer.
6501 @end deffn
6502 @end deffn
6503
6504 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6505 @cindex kinetis_ke
6506 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6507 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6508 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6509 autoconfigures itself.
6510 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6511
6512 @example
6513 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6514 @end example
6515
6516 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6517 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6518 @end deffn
6519
6520 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6521 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6522 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6523 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6524 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6525 @end deffn
6526
6527 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6528 Command disables watchdog timer.
6529 @end deffn
6530 @end deffn
6531
6532 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6533 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6534 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6535 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6536 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6537
6538 @quotation Note
6539 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6540 driver:
6541 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6542 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6543 @end quotation
6544
6545 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6546 which must appear in the following order:
6547
6548 @itemize
6549 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6550 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6551 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6552 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6553 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6554 LPC43x[2357])
6555 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6556 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6557 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6558 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6559 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6560 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6561 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6562 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6563 at which the core is running
6564 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6565 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6566 @quotation Note
6567 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6568 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6569 However, if you do provide it,
6570 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6571 @end quotation
6572 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6573 ROM IAP entry point.
6574 @end itemize
6575
6576 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6577
6578 @example
6579 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6580 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6581 @end example
6582
6583 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6584 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6585 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6586 @end deffn
6587 @end deffn
6588
6589 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6590 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6591 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6592 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6593 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6594 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6595
6596 @example
6597 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6598 @end example
6599 @end deffn
6600
6601 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6602 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6603 from NXP.
6604
6605 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6606 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6607 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6608 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6609 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6610 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6611 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6612 you start the PLL.
6613
6614 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6615
6616 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6617 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6618 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6619
6620 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6621 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6622 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6623 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6624 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6625 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6626 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6627
6628 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6629 @example
6630 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6631 @end example
6632
6633 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6634 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6635 @code{flash banks} command.
6636
6637 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6638 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6639 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6640 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6641 a known signature.
6642 Example:
6643 @example
6644 lpc2900 signature 0
6645 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6646 @end example
6647 @end deffn
6648
6649 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6650 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6651 saves it to a file in binary format.
6652 Example:
6653 @example
6654 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6655 @end example
6656 @end deffn
6657
6658 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6659 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6660 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6661 command:
6662
6663 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6664 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6665 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6666 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6667
6668 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6669 Example:
6670 @example
6671 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6672 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6673 @end example
6674 @end deffn
6675
6676 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6677 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6678 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6679 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6680 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6681 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6682 912 bytes.
6683 @quotation Attention
6684 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6685 @end quotation
6686 Example:
6687 @example
6688 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6689 @end example
6690 @end deffn
6691
6692 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6693 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6694 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6695 after the next power cycle.
6696 @quotation Attention
6697 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6698 @end quotation
6699 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6700 Example:
6701 @example
6702 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6703 flash info 0
6704 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6705 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6706 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6707 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6708 @end example
6709 @end deffn
6710
6711 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6712 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6713 effective after the next power cycle.
6714 @quotation Attention
6715 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6716 @end quotation
6717 Examples:
6718 @example
6719 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6720 @end example
6721 @end deffn
6722 @end deffn
6723
6724 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6725 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6726 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6727 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6728
6729 @example
6730 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6731 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6732 @end example
6733
6734 @itemize @bullet
6735 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6736 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6737 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6738 @end itemize
6739
6740 Example usage:
6741 @example
6742 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6743 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6744 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6745 @} else @{
6746 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6747 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6748 @}
6749 @end example
6750 @end deffn
6751
6752 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
6753 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6754 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6755 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6756 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6757 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6758
6759 @example
6760 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6761 @end example
6762
6763 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6764 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6765 only the main program flash.
6766
6767 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6768 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6769 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6770 @end deffn
6771
6772 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6773 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6774 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6775 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6776
6777 To erase and program the BSL:
6778 @example
6779 msp432 bsl unlock
6780 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6781 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6782 msp432 bsl lock
6783 @end example
6784 @end deffn
6785 @end deffn
6786
6787 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
6788 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6789 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6790 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6791 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6792 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6793 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6794 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6795 also have division into regions: main and info.
6796 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6797 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6798
6799 @example
6800 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6801 @end example
6802
6803 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6804
6805 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6806 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6807 @end deffn
6808
6809 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6810 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6811 @end deffn
6812
6813 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6814 Erase all userflash including info region.
6815 @end deffn
6816
6817 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6818 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6819 @end deffn
6820
6821 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6822 Check sectors protect.
6823 @end deffn
6824
6825 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6826 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6827 @end deffn
6828
6829 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6830 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6831 @end deffn
6832
6833 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6834 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6835 @end deffn
6836
6837 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6838 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6839 @end deffn
6840
6841 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6842 Show information about flash driver.
6843 @end deffn
6844
6845 @end deffn
6846
6847 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
6848 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
6849 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
6850 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
6851 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
6852
6853 @example
6854 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6855 @end example
6856 @end deffn
6857
6858 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
6859 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6860 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core. nRF52 family powered
6861 by ARM Cortex-M4 or M4F core is supported too. nRF52832 is fully supported
6862 including BPROT flash protection scheme. nRF52833 and nRF52840 devices are
6863 supported with the exception of security extensions (flash access control list
6864 - ACL).
6865
6866 @example
6867 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6868 @end example
6869
6870 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6871
6872 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
6873 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6874 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6875 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6876 code.
6877 @end deffn
6878
6879 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
6880 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6881 @end deffn
6882
6883 @end deffn
6884
6885 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
6886 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6887 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6888
6889 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6890 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6891 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6892 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6893
6894 @example
6895 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6896 @end example
6897 @end deffn
6898
6899 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
6900 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6901 and integrate flash memory.
6902
6903 @example
6904 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6905 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6906 @end example
6907
6908 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6909 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6910 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6911 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6912 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6913 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6914 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6915 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6916 @end deffn
6917 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
6918 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6919 This will remove any Code Protection.
6920 @end deffn
6921 @end deffn
6922
6923 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
6924 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6925 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6926 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6927 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6928
6929 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6930 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6931
6932 @example
6933 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6934 @end example
6935
6936 psoc4-specific commands
6937 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6938 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6939
6940 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6941 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6942
6943 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6944 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6945 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6946
6947 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6948 @end deffn
6949
6950 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6951 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6952
6953 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6954 @end deffn
6955 @end deffn
6956
6957 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
6958 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6959 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6960 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6961 apart from the base address.
6962
6963 @example
6964 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6965 @end example
6966
6967 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6968 @quotation Attention
6969 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6970 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6971 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6972 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6973 @end quotation
6974
6975 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6976
6977 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6978 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6979 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6980 @end deffn
6981 @end deffn
6982
6983 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
6984 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6985 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6986 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6987 apart from the base address.
6988
6989 @example
6990 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6991 $_TARGETNAME
6992 @end example
6993 @end deffn
6994
6995 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
6996 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6997 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6998 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6999
7000 @example
7001 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7002 @end example
7003
7004 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
7005
7006 @itemize
7007 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
7008 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
7009 @end itemize
7010
7011 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
7012
7013 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
7014 @quotation Attention
7015 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
7016 after successful write.
7017 @end quotation
7018 @end deffn
7019
7020 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
7021 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
7022 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
7023 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
7024
7025 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
7026 @itemize @bullet
7027 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
7028 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
7029 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
7030 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
7031 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
7032 row size: 512 bytes.
7033 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
7034 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
7035 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
7036 operation will erase row automatically.
7037 @end itemize
7038
7039 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
7040 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
7041
7042 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
7043
7044 @example
7045 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7046 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7047 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7048 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7049 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7050 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7051 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7052 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7053 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7054 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7055 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7056 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7057
7058 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7059 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7060 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7061 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7062 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7063 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7064 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7065 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7066 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7067 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7068 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7069 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7070 @end example
7071
7072 psoc6-specific commands
7073 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7074 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7075 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7076 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7077 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7078 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7079 @end deffn
7080
7081 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7082 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7083 by @command{flash banks}.
7084 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7085 @end deffn
7086 @end deffn
7087
7088 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7089 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7090 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7091 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7092 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7093
7094 @example
7095 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7096 @end example
7097 @end deffn
7098
7099 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7100 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7101 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7102 and SWD interface.
7103 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7104 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7105
7106 @example
7107 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7108 @end example
7109
7110 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7111
7112 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7113 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7114 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7115 @end deffn
7116
7117 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7118 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7119 @end deffn
7120 @end deffn
7121
7122 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7123 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7124 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7125 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7126 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7127
7128 @example
7129 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7130 @end example
7131
7132 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7133 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7134 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7135 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7136 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7137 disabled.
7138
7139 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7140 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7141 @quotation Warning
7142 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7143 applied to all of them.
7144 @end quotation
7145 @end deffn
7146 @end deffn
7147
7148 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7149 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7150 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7151 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7152 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7153 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7154
7155 @example
7156 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7157 @end example
7158
7159 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7160 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7161 the flash driver.
7162
7163 @example
7164 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7165 @end example
7166
7167 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7168 as per the following example.
7169 @example
7170 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7171 @end example
7172
7173 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7174
7175 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7176 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7177 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7178 @end deffn
7179
7180 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7181 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7182 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7183 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7184 @end deffn
7185
7186 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7187 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7188 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7189 @end deffn
7190
7191 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7192 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7193 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7194 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7195 @end deffn
7196
7197 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7198 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7199 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7200 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7201 @end deffn
7202
7203 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7204 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7205 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7206 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7207 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7208 @end deffn
7209 @end deffn
7210
7211 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7212 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7213 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7214 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7215 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7216
7217 @example
7218 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7219 @end example
7220
7221 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7222 as per the following example.
7223 @example
7224 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7225 @end example
7226
7227 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7228 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7229 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7230 @end deffn
7231
7232 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7233 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7234 the flash driver.
7235
7236 @example
7237 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7238 @end example
7239
7240 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7241
7242 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7243 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7244 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7245 @end deffn
7246
7247 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7248 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7249 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7250 @end deffn
7251
7252 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7253 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7254 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7255 @end deffn
7256
7257 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7258 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7259 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7260 @end deffn
7261
7262 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7263 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7264 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7265 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7266 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7267 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7268 @end deffn
7269
7270 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7271 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7272 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7273 @end deffn
7274 @end deffn
7275
7276 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7277 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7278 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7279 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7280 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7281
7282 @example
7283 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7284 @end example
7285
7286 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7287 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7288 the flash driver.
7289
7290 @example
7291 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7292 @end example
7293
7294 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7295
7296 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7297 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7298 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7299 @end deffn
7300
7301 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7302 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7303 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7304 @end deffn
7305
7306 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7307 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7308 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7309 @end deffn
7310
7311 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7312 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7313 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7314 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7315 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7316
7317 Example usage:
7318 @example
7319 # read OPTSR_CUR
7320 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7321 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7322 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7323 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7324 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7325 @end example
7326 @end deffn
7327
7328 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7329 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7330 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7331 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7332 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7333 will be touched).
7334
7335 Example usage:
7336 @example
7337 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7338 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7339 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7340 @end example
7341 @end deffn
7342 @end deffn
7343
7344 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7345 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7346 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7347 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7348 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7349
7350 @example
7351 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7352 @end example
7353
7354 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7355 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7356 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7357 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7358 second bank.
7359
7360 @example
7361 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7362 @end example
7363
7364 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7365
7366 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7367 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7368 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7369 @end deffn
7370
7371 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7372 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7373 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7374 @end deffn
7375
7376 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7377 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7378 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7379 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7380 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7381 @end deffn
7382 @end deffn
7383
7384 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7385 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7386 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7387 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7388 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7389 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7390
7391 @example
7392 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7393 @end example
7394
7395 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7396 as per the following example.
7397 @example
7398 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7399 @end example
7400
7401 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7402 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7403 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7404 @end deffn
7405
7406 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7407 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7408 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7409 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7410
7411 @example
7412 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7413 @end example
7414
7415 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7416
7417 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7418 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7419 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7420
7421 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7422 @end deffn
7423
7424 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7425 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7426 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7427
7428 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7429 @end deffn
7430
7431 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7432 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7433 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7434 @end deffn
7435
7436 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7437 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7438 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7439 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7440
7441 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7442 @example
7443 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7444 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7445 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7446 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7447 @end example
7448
7449 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7450 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7451 @end deffn
7452
7453 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7454 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7455 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7456 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7457 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7458
7459 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7460
7461 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7462 @example
7463 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7464 @end example
7465
7466 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7467 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7468 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7469 @end deffn
7470
7471 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7472 List the protected areas using WRP.
7473 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7474 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7475 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7476
7477 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7478 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7479 in single or dual-banks mode.
7480 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7481 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7482
7483 @end deffn
7484
7485 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7486 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7487 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7488 @end deffn
7489
7490 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7491 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7492 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7493 the TrustZone status.
7494 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7495 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7496 @end deffn
7497 @end deffn
7498
7499 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7500 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7501 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7502 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7503 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7504
7505 @example
7506 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7507 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7508 @end example
7509
7510 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7511 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7512 for the specified flash bank.
7513 @end deffn
7514 @end deffn
7515
7516 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7517 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7518 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7519 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7520 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7521
7522 @example
7523 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7524 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7525 @end example
7526
7527 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7528 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7529 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7530
7531 @itemize @bullet
7532 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7533 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7534 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7535 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7536 @end itemize
7537 @end deffn
7538
7539 @end deffn
7540
7541 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7542 @cindex str9xpec
7543
7544 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7545 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7546 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7547 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7548
7549 Here is some background info to help
7550 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7551 the str9:
7552 @enumerate
7553 @item
7554 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7555 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7556 @item
7557 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7558 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7559 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7560 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7561 @end enumerate
7562
7563 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7564 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7565 configured for flash bank 0.
7566 @example
7567 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7568 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7569 adapter assert srst
7570 # turn off target polling
7571 poll off
7572 # disable str9 core
7573 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7574 # read option bytes
7575 str9xpec options_read 0
7576 # re-enable str9 core
7577 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7578 poll on
7579 reset halt
7580 @end example
7581 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7582 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7583 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7584 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7585
7586 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7587
7588 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7589 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7590 @end deffn
7591
7592 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7593 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7594 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7595 @end deffn
7596
7597 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7598 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7599 erase the device.
7600 @end deffn
7601
7602 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7603 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7604 @end deffn
7605
7606 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7607 Configure str9 boot bank.
7608 @end deffn
7609
7610 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7611 Configure str9 lvd source.
7612 @end deffn
7613
7614 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7615 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7616 @end deffn
7617
7618 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7619 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7620 @end deffn
7621
7622 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7623 Read str9 option bytes.
7624 @end deffn
7625
7626 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7627 Write str9 option bytes.
7628 @end deffn
7629
7630 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7631 unlock str9 device.
7632 @end deffn
7633
7634 @end deffn
7635
7636 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7637 @cindex swm050
7638 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7639
7640 @example
7641 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7642 @end example
7643
7644 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7645
7646 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7647 Erases the entire flash bank.
7648 @end deffn
7649
7650 @end deffn
7651
7652
7653 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7654 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7655 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7656 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7657
7658 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7659
7660 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7661 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7662 @end deffn
7663
7664 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
7665 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7666 @end deffn
7667
7668 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7669 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7670 the flash clock.
7671 @end deffn
7672 @end deffn
7673
7674 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7675 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7676 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7677 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7678 correct bank config.
7679
7680 @example
7681 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7682 @end example
7683 @end deffn
7684
7685 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7686 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7687 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7688 @end deffn
7689
7690 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7691 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7692 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7693
7694 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7695
7696 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7697 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7698 @end deffn
7699
7700 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7701 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7702 @end deffn
7703
7704 @end deffn
7705
7706 @section NAND Flash Commands
7707 @cindex NAND
7708
7709 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7710 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7711 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7712
7713 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7714 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7715 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7716 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7717 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7718 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7719
7720 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7721 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7722 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7723 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7724 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7725 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7726 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7727 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7728 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7729 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7730
7731 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7732 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7733 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7734 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7735 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7736 every 512 bytes of data.
7737
7738 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7739 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7740 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7741 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7742 ECC mode is used.
7743
7744 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7745 @enumerate
7746 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7747 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7748 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7749 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7750 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7751 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7752 to access that device.
7753 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7754 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7755 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7756 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7757 de-brick a board.
7758 @end enumerate
7759
7760 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7761 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7762 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7763 are only 32 bits wide.
7764 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7765 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7766 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7767 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7768
7769 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7770 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7771 @cindex NAND configuration
7772
7773 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7774 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7775 OpenOCD has initialized.
7776
7777 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7778 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7779 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7780 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7781 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7782 they were a single (larger) device.
7783 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7784 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7785
7786 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7787 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7788 configuration files, not interactively.
7789
7790 @itemize @bullet
7791 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7792 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7793 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7794 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7795 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7796 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7797 commands to the NAND controller.
7798 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7799 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7800 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7801 for more information.
7802 @end itemize
7803 @end deffn
7804
7805 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
7806 Prints a summary of each device declared
7807 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7808 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7809 @example
7810 > nand list
7811 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7812 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7813 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7814 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7815 >
7816 @end example
7817 @end deffn
7818
7819 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
7820 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7821 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7822 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7823 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7824 it with most other NAND commands.
7825 @end deffn
7826
7827 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7828
7829 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7830 @cindex NAND reading
7831 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7832 starting at the specified offset.
7833 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7834
7835 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7836 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7837
7838 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7839 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7840 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7841
7842 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7843 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7844 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7845 method which handled that error correction.
7846
7847 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7848 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7849 @itemize @bullet
7850 @item no oob_* parameter
7851 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7852 @item @code{oob_raw}
7853 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7854 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7855 spare areas associated with each data page.
7856 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7857 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7858 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7859 @item @code{oob_only}
7860 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7861 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7862 spare areas associated with each data page.
7863 @end itemize
7864 @end deffn
7865
7866 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
7867 @cindex NAND erasing
7868 @cindex NAND programming
7869 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7870 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7871 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7872 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7873 If those parameters are not specified,
7874 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7875 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7876
7877 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7878 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7879 block marker.
7880 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7881 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7882 @end deffn
7883
7884 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7885 @cindex NAND writing
7886 @cindex NAND programming
7887 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7888 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7889 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7890 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7891
7892 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7893 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7894
7895 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7896 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7897 past the end of the device.
7898 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7899 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7900 if that's being written.)
7901
7902 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7903 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7904 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7905
7906 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7907 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7908 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7909 @itemize @bullet
7910 @item no oob_* parameter
7911 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7912 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7913 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7914 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7915 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7916 @item @code{oob_only}
7917 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7918 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7919 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7920 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7921 @item @code{oob_raw}
7922 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7923 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7924 un-altered OOB.
7925 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7926 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7927 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7928 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7929 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7930 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7931 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7932 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7933 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7934 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7935 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7936 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7937 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7938 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7939 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7940 @end itemize
7941 @end deffn
7942
7943 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7944 @cindex NAND verification
7945 @cindex NAND programming
7946 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7947 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7948 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7949
7950 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7951 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7952
7953 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7954 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7955 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7956 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7957 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7958
7959 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7960 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7961 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7962
7963 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7964 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7965 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7966 be removed in a future release.
7967 @end deffn
7968
7969 @subsection Other NAND commands
7970 @cindex NAND other commands
7971
7972 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7973 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7974 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7975 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7976 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7977 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7978 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7979 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7980
7981 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7982 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7983 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7984 @end deffn
7985
7986 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
7987 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7988 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7989 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7990 status for each block.
7991 @end deffn
7992
7993 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7994 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7995 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7996
7997 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7998 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7999 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
8000 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
8001 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
8002
8003 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
8004 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
8005 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
8006 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
8007 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
8008 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
8009 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
8010 @end deffn
8011
8012 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
8013 @subsection NAND Driver List
8014 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
8015 driver-specific options and behaviors.
8016 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
8017
8018 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
8019 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
8020 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
8021 address of the ECC controller.
8022 @example
8023 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
8024 @end example
8025 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
8026 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
8027 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
8028 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
8029 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
8030 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
8031 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
8032 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8033 @end deffn
8034 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
8035 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
8036 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8037 @end deffn
8038
8039 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
8040 properly configured for input or output.
8041 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
8042 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
8043 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8044 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8045 @end deffn
8046 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
8047 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8048 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8049 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8050 @end deffn
8051 @end deffn
8052
8053 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8054 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8055 chips from Texas Instruments.
8056 It takes three extra parameters:
8057 address of the NAND chip;
8058 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8059 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8060 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8061 @example
8062 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8063 @end example
8064 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8065 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8066 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8067 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8068 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8069 @end deffn
8070
8071 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8072 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8073 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8074 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8075 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8076 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8077 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8078 @end deffn
8079
8080 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8081 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8082 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8083 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8084 @end deffn
8085 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8086
8087 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8088 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8089 should work for this chip as well.
8090 @end deffn
8091
8092 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8093 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8094 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8095 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8096 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8097 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8098 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8099 @example
8100 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8101 @end example
8102 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8103 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8104 without parameter query status.
8105 @end deffn
8106 @end deffn
8107
8108 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8109 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8110 parameter: the address of the controller.
8111 @example
8112 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8113 @end example
8114 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8115 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8116 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8117 change any behavior.
8118 @end deffn
8119
8120 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8121 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8122 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8123 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8124 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8125 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8126 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8127 specialized commands.
8128 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8129 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8130 change any behavior.
8131 @end deffn
8132
8133 @node Flash Programming
8134 @chapter Flash Programming
8135
8136 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8137 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8138 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8139
8140 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8141 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8142
8143 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8144 @enumerate
8145 @item 'init' is executed.
8146 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8147 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8148 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8149 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8150 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8151 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8152 @end enumerate
8153
8154 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8155
8156 @example
8157 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8158 # are optional parameters
8159 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8160 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8161
8162 # binary files need the flash address passing
8163 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8164 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8165 @end example
8166
8167 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8168 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8169 @cindex PLD
8170 @cindex FPGA
8171
8172 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8173 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8174 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8175 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8176 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8177 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8178 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8179
8180 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8181
8182 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8183 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8184 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8185
8186 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8187 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8188
8189 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8190 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8191 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8192 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8193 behavior.
8194 @end deffn
8195
8196 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8197 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8198 @end deffn
8199
8200 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8201 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8202 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8203 @end deffn
8204
8205 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8206
8207 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8208 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8209 that particular type of PLD.
8210
8211 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8212 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8213 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8214
8215 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8216 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8217 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8218
8219 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8220 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8221 for FPGA @var{num}.
8222 @end deffn
8223 @end deffn
8224
8225 @node General Commands
8226 @chapter General Commands
8227 @cindex commands
8228
8229 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8230 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8231 commands are documented elsewhere.
8232
8233 Intent:
8234 @itemize @bullet
8235 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8236 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8237 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8238 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8239
8240 @item @b{From the human}
8241 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8242 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8243
8244 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8245 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8246 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8247
8248 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8249 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8250 port is 5555.
8251 @end itemize
8252
8253
8254 @section Server Commands
8255
8256 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8257 Exits the current telnet session.
8258 @end deffn
8259
8260 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8261 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8262 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8263 Not every command provides helptext.
8264
8265 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8266 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8267 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8268 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8269 @end deffn
8270
8271 @deffn {Command} {usage} [string]
8272 With no parameters, prints usage text for all commands. Otherwise,
8273 prints all usage text of which command, help text, and usage text
8274 containing @var{string}.
8275 Not every command provides helptext.
8276 @end deffn
8277
8278 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8279 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8280 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8281 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8282 Useful in connection with script files
8283 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8284 @end deffn
8285
8286 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8287 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8288 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8289 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8290
8291 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8292 @example
8293 # redefine shutdown
8294 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8295 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8296 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8297 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8298 original_shutdown
8299 @}
8300 @end example
8301 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8302 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8303 @end deffn
8304
8305 @anchor{debuglevel}
8306 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8307 @cindex message level
8308 Display debug level.
8309 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8310 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8311 Level 0 is error messages only;
8312 level 1 adds warnings;
8313 level 2 adds informational messages;
8314 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8315 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8316 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8317 the command line along with the location of that log
8318 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8319 @xref{Running}.
8320 @end deffn
8321
8322 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8323 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8324 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8325 @example
8326 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8327 @end example
8328 @end deffn
8329
8330 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8331 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8332 the default log output channel is stderr.
8333 @end deffn
8334
8335 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8336 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8337 @end deffn
8338
8339 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8340 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8341 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8342 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8343 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8344 @end deffn
8345
8346 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8347 @section Target State handling
8348 @cindex reset
8349 @cindex halt
8350 @cindex target initialization
8351
8352 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8353 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8354 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8355 a current target which is used to perform the
8356 various operations. The current target may be changed
8357 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8358 target which should become current.
8359
8360 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8361 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8362 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8363 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8364 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8365
8366 @emph{With no arguments}:
8367 list all available registers for the current target,
8368 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8369 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8370 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8371 are flagged as such.
8372
8373 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8374 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8375 bypassing any internal cache.
8376
8377 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8378 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8379 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8380 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8381 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8382 relevant module will flush such values.
8383
8384 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8385 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8386
8387 @example
8388 > reg
8389 ===== ARM registers
8390 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8391 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8392 (2) r2 (/32)
8393 ...
8394 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8395 >
8396 @end example
8397 @end deffn
8398
8399 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8400 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8401 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8402 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8403 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8404 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8405 (and enter debug mode).
8406 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8407
8408 @quotation Warning
8409 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8410 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8411 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8412 power mode by gating the core clock;
8413 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8414
8415 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8416 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8417 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8418 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8419 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8420 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8421
8422 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8423 work with a JTAG debugger.
8424 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8425 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8426 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8427 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8428 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8429 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8430 @end quotation
8431
8432 @end deffn
8433
8434 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8435 Resume the target at its current code position,
8436 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8437 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8438 @end deffn
8439
8440 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8441 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8442 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8443 @end deffn
8444
8445 @anchor{resetcommand}
8446 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8447 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8448 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8449 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8450 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8451 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8452 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8453
8454 The optional parameter specifies what should
8455 happen after the reset.
8456 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8457 The other options will not work on all systems.
8458 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8459
8460 @itemize @minus
8461 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8462 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8463 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8464 @end itemize
8465 @end deffn
8466
8467 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8468 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8469 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8470 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8471 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8472 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8473 state.
8474 @end deffn
8475
8476 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8477 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8478 Set values of reset signals.
8479 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8480 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8481 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8482 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8483
8484 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8485 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8486 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8487 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8488 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8489 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8490 the signal will not be modified.
8491
8492 @quotation Note
8493 TRST is specially handled.
8494 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8495 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8496 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8497 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8498 instead of the TRST signal.
8499 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8500 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8501 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8502 with handlers for that event.
8503 @end quotation
8504 @end deffn
8505
8506 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8507 @section Memory access commands
8508 @cindex memory access
8509
8510 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8511 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8512 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8513 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8514
8515 @enumerate
8516 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8517 to change the current target.
8518 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8519 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8520 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8521 @end enumerate
8522
8523 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8524 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8525 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8526 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8527 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8528 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8529 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8530 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8531 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8532 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8533 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8534 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8535 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8536 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8537 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8538 @end deffn
8539
8540 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8541 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8542 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8543 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8544 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8545 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8546 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8547 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8548 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8549 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8550 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8551 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8552 @end deffn
8553
8554 @anchor{imageaccess}
8555 @section Image loading commands
8556 @cindex image loading
8557 @cindex image dumping
8558
8559 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8560 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8561 binary file named @var{filename}.
8562 @end deffn
8563
8564 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8565 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8566 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8567 @end deffn
8568
8569 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8570 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8571 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8572 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8573 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8574 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8575 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8576 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8577 separately.
8578 @end deffn
8579
8580 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8581 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8582 The file format may optionally be specified
8583 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8584 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8585 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8586 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8587 @example
8588 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8589 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8590 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8591 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8592 $address $length
8593 @}
8594 @end example
8595 @end deffn
8596
8597 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8598 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8599 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8600 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8601 The file format may optionally be specified
8602 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8603 @end deffn
8604
8605 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8606 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8607 The file format may optionally be specified
8608 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8609 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8610 @end deffn
8611
8612 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8613 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8614 The file format may optionally be specified
8615 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8616 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8617 @end deffn
8618
8619
8620 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8621 @cindex breakpoint
8622 @cindex watchpoint
8623
8624 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8625 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8626 watchpoints.
8627 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8628
8629 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8630 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8631 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8632 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8633 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8634 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8635
8636 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8637 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8638 @end deffn
8639
8640 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8641 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8642 @end deffn
8643
8644 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8645 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8646 @end deffn
8647
8648 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8649 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8650 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8651 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8652 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8653 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8654 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8655 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8656 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8657 @end deffn
8658
8659
8660 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8661
8662 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8663 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8664 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8665 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8666 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8667 running, can be used.
8668 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8669 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8670 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8671
8672 @quotation Note
8673 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8674 @end quotation
8675
8676 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8677 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8678 communication, respectively.
8679
8680 @quotation Note
8681 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8682 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8683 example.
8684 @end quotation
8685
8686 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8687 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8688 of TCP/IP connections.
8689
8690 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
8691 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8692 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8693 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8694 @var{size} bytes.
8695 @end deffn
8696
8697 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
8698 Start RTT.
8699 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8700 @end deffn
8701
8702 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
8703 Stop RTT.
8704 @end deffn
8705
8706 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
8707 Display the polling interval.
8708 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8709 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8710 checked for new data.
8711 @end deffn
8712
8713 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
8714 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8715 @end deffn
8716
8717 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
8718 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8719 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8720 @end deffn
8721
8722 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
8723 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8724 @end deffn
8725
8726 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
8727 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8728 @end deffn
8729
8730 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8731 on the target device.
8732
8733 @example
8734 resume
8735
8736 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8737 rtt start
8738
8739 rtt server start 9090 0
8740 @end example
8741
8742 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8743 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8744 TCP/IP port 9090.
8745
8746
8747 @section Misc Commands
8748
8749 @cindex profiling
8750 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8751 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8752 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8753 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8754 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8755 limit the address range.
8756 @end deffn
8757
8758 @deffn {Command} {version}
8759 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8760 @end deffn
8761
8762 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
8763 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8764 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8765 @end deffn
8766
8767 @deffn {Command} {add_help_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
8768 Add or replace help text on the given @var{command_name}.
8769 @end deffn
8770
8771 @deffn {Command} {add_usage_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
8772 Add or replace usage text on the given @var{command_name}.
8773 @end deffn
8774
8775 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8776 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8777 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8778 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8779
8780 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8781 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8782 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8783 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8784
8785 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8786 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8787 @cindex tracing
8788 @cindex ETM
8789 @cindex ETB
8790
8791 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8792 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8793 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8794
8795 @itemize
8796 @item
8797 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8798 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8799 supports such an interface.
8800 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8801 and trace port support.)
8802 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8803 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8804 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8805 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8806 in the board-specific configuration file.
8807 @item
8808 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8809 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8810 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8811 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8812 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8813 @end itemize
8814
8815 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8816
8817 @quotation Issues
8818 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8819 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8820
8821 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8822 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8823 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8824 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8825 dummy trace port driver}.
8826
8827 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8828 as well as tracing only during specific states
8829 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8830
8831 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8832 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8833 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8834 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8835 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8836
8837 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8838 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8839 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8840 this original style of JTAG access.
8841 @end quotation
8842
8843 @subsection ETM Configuration
8844 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8845
8846 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8847 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8848 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8849
8850 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8851 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8852 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8853 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8854 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8855 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8856 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8857 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8858 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8859
8860 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8861 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8862 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8863
8864 @quotation Warning
8865 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8866 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8867 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8868 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8869 @end quotation
8870
8871 @quotation Note
8872 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8873 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8874 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8875 what CPU activities are traced.
8876 @end quotation
8877 @end deffn
8878
8879 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
8880 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8881 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8882 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8883 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8884 @end deffn
8885
8886 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
8887 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8888 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8889 Did trace data overflow?
8890 Was it triggered?
8891 @end deffn
8892
8893 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8894 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8895 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8896 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8897 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8898
8899 @itemize
8900 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8901 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8902 The value is one of
8903 @option{none} (save nothing),
8904 @option{data} (save data),
8905 @option{address} (save addresses),
8906 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8907 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8908 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8909 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8910 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8911 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8912 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8913 trace stream without an image of the code.
8914 @end itemize
8915 @end deffn
8916
8917 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8918 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8919 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8920 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8921 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8922
8923 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8924 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8925 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8926 @end deffn
8927
8928 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8929
8930 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8931 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8932 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8933
8934 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8935 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8936 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8937 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8938 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8939 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8940 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8941
8942 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8943
8944 @itemize
8945 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8946 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8947 for instruction access within that function's body.
8948 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8949 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8950 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8951 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8952 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8953 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8954 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8955 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8956 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8957 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8958 @item @emph{... more}
8959 @end itemize
8960
8961 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8962 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8963
8964 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
8965 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8966 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8967 @end deffn
8968
8969 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
8970 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8971 @end deffn
8972
8973 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8974 Opens an image file.
8975 @end deffn
8976
8977 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
8978 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8979 @end deffn
8980
8981 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
8982 Starts trace data collection.
8983 @end deffn
8984
8985 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
8986 Stops trace data collection.
8987 @end deffn
8988
8989 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8990 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8991
8992 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8993
8994 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
8995 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8996 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8997 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8998 any trace data collection.}
8999 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
9000 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
9001 @end deffn
9002 @end deffn
9003
9004 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
9005 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
9006 to use on-chip ETB memory.
9007 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
9008 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
9009 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
9010 @end deffn
9011 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
9012 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
9013 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
9014 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
9015 trace trigger becomes active.
9016
9017 @itemize
9018 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
9019 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
9020 afterwards.
9021 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
9022 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
9023 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
9024 what caused that event to happen.
9025 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
9026 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
9027 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
9028 how the event caused trouble.
9029 @end itemize
9030 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
9031 @end deffn
9032
9033 @end deffn
9034
9035 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
9036 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
9037 @cindex CTI
9038
9039 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
9040 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
9041 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
9042 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
9043 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
9044 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
9045
9046 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
9047 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
9048 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
9049 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
9050 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
9051 including additional configuration.
9052 @end deffn
9053
9054 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
9055 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
9056 @end deffn
9057
9058 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
9059 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
9060 @end deffn
9061
9062 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9063 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9064 @end deffn
9065
9066 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9067 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9068 @end deffn
9069
9070 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9071 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9072 @end deffn
9073
9074 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9075 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9076 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9077 @end deffn
9078
9079 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9080 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9081 of the CTI.
9082 @end deffn
9083
9084 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9085 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9086 useful in TCL scripting.
9087 @end deffn
9088
9089 @section Generic ARM
9090 @cindex ARM
9091
9092 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9093 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9094 commands that may be available.
9095
9096 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9097 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9098 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9099 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9100 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9101 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9102 @end deffn
9103
9104 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9105 @cindex disassemble
9106 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9107 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9108 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9109 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9110 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9111 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9112 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9113
9114 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9115 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9116 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9117 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9118 with a handful of exceptions.
9119 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9120 @end deffn
9121
9122 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9123 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9124 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9125 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9126 and using the MCR instruction.
9127 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9128 an ARM register.)
9129 @end deffn
9130
9131 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9132 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9133 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9134 and the MRC instruction.
9135 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9136 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9137 an ARM register.)
9138 @end deffn
9139
9140 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9141 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9142 core mode if necessary.
9143 @end deffn
9144
9145 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9146 @cindex ARM semihosting
9147 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9148
9149 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9150 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9151 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9152 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9153 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9154 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9155 @end deffn
9156
9157 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9158 @cindex ARM semihosting
9159 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9160
9161 @example
9162 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9163 @end example
9164
9165 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9166 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9167 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9168 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9169 @end deffn
9170
9171 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9172 @cindex ARM semihosting
9173 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9174 status.
9175
9176 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9177 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9178 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9179 debugger.
9180 @end deffn
9181
9182 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9183 @cindex ARM semihosting
9184 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9185
9186 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9187 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9188 the value returned by the target.
9189
9190 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9191 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9192 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9193 encountering a break.
9194
9195 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9196 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9197 to the debugger.
9198 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9199 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9200 request or equivalent").
9201
9202 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9203 this option (default: disabled).
9204 @end deffn
9205
9206 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9207 @cindex ARMv4
9208 @cindex ARMv5
9209
9210 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9211 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9212 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9213 variant.
9214
9215 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9216 @cindex ARM7
9217 @cindex ARM9
9218
9219 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9220 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9221 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9222 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9223
9224 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9225 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9226 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9227 instead of breakpoints.
9228 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9229
9230 This should be
9231 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9232 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9233 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9234 @end deffn
9235
9236 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9237 @cindex DCC
9238 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9239 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9240 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9241
9242 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9243 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9244 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9245 @end deffn
9246
9247 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9248 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9249 that don't check completion of the operation.
9250 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9251
9252 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9253 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9254 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9255 @end deffn
9256
9257 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9258 @cindex ARM9
9259
9260 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9261 integer processors.
9262 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9263
9264 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9265 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9266 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9267 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9268
9269 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9270 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9271 @cindex vector_catch
9272 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9273 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9274 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9275 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9276 to those hardware vectors.
9277
9278 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9279 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9280 vector catch hardware to intercept
9281 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9282 @option{none} of them,
9283 or a list with one or more of the following:
9284 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9285 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9286 @end deffn
9287
9288 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9289 @cindex ARM920T
9290
9291 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9292 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9293 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9294 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9295 and ARM9 commands.
9296
9297 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9298 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9299 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9300 @end deffn
9301
9302 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9303 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9304 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9305 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9306 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9307 (Not all registers can be written.)
9308 @end deffn
9309
9310 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9311 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9312 @end deffn
9313
9314 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9315 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9316 @end deffn
9317
9318 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9319 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9320
9321 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9322 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9323 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9324 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9325 and ARM9 commands.
9326
9327 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9328 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9329
9330 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9331 Print information about the caches found.
9332 @end deffn
9333
9334 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9335 @cindex ARM966E
9336
9337 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9338 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9339 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9340 and ARM9 commands.
9341
9342 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9343 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9344 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9345 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9346 ARM966E-S TRM.
9347 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9348 as required for BIST support.
9349 @end deffn
9350
9351 @subsection XScale specific commands
9352 @cindex XScale
9353
9354 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9355
9356 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9357 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9358 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9359 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9360 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9361 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9362 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9363
9364 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9365 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9366 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9367 the mini-IC.
9368
9369 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9370 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9371 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9372 code layout in memory:
9373 @example
9374 _vectors:
9375 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9376 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9377 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9378 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9379 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9380 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9381 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9382 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9383 .org 0x100
9384 .long real_reset_vector
9385 .long real_ui_handler
9386 .long real_swi_handler
9387 .long real_pf_abort
9388 .long real_data_abort
9389 .long 0 /* unused */
9390 .long real_irq_handler
9391 .long real_fiq_handler
9392 @end example
9393
9394 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9395 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9396 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9397 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9398 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9399 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9400 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9401 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9402 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9403 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9404 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9405 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9406 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9407 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9408 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9409 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9410 software.
9411
9412 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9413 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9414 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9415 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9416
9417 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9418 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9419 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9420 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9421 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9422 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9423 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9424 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9425 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9426
9427 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9428 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9429
9430 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9431 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9432 @end deffn
9433
9434 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9435 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9436 @end deffn
9437
9438 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9439 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9440 @end deffn
9441
9442 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9443 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9444 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9445 @end deffn
9446
9447 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9448 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9449 @end deffn
9450
9451 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9452 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9453 @end deffn
9454
9455 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9456 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9457 @end deffn
9458
9459 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9460 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9461 @end deffn
9462
9463 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9464 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9465 @end deffn
9466
9467 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9468 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9469 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9470 and modifying how it is emptied.
9471 @end deffn
9472
9473 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9474 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9475 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9476 The image @var{type} may be one of
9477 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9478 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9479 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9480 @end deffn
9481
9482 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9483 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9484 @cindex vector_catch
9485 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9486 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9487
9488 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9489 @example
9490 0x01 Trap Reset
9491 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9492 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9493 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9494 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9495 0x20 reserved
9496 0x40 Trap IRQ
9497 0x80 Trap FIQ
9498 @end example
9499 @end deffn
9500
9501 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9502 @cindex vector_table
9503
9504 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9505 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9506 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9507 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9508 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9509
9510 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9511
9512 @end deffn
9513
9514 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9515 @cindex ARMv6
9516
9517 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9518 @cindex ARM11
9519
9520 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9521 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9522 which is enabled by default.
9523 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9524 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9525 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9526 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9527 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9528 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9529 @end deffn
9530
9531 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9532 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9533 which is enabled by default.
9534 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9535 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9536 @end deffn
9537
9538 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9539 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9540 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9541 they are disabled by default.
9542 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9543 @end deffn
9544
9545 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9546 @cindex vector_catch
9547 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9548 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9549 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9550
9551 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9552 for certain hardware events.
9553 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9554 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9555 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9556 @end deffn
9557
9558 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9559 @cindex ARMv7
9560 @cindex ARMv8
9561
9562 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9563 @cindex Cortex-A
9564
9565 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9566 display information about target caches
9567 @end deffn
9568
9569 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9570 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9571 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9572 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9573 Defaults to 'off'.
9574 @end deffn
9575
9576 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9577 Initialize core debug
9578 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9579 @end deffn
9580
9581 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9582 Display/set the current SMP mode
9583 @end deffn
9584
9585 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9586 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9587 @end deffn
9588
9589 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9590 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9591 @end deffn
9592
9593 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9594 configure l2x cache
9595 @end deffn
9596
9597 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9598 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9599 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9600 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9601 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9602 @end deffn
9603
9604 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9605 @cindex Cortex-R
9606
9607 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
9608 Initialize core debug
9609 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9610 @end deffn
9611
9612 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9613 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9614 @end deffn
9615
9616
9617 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9618 @cindex tracing
9619 @cindex SWO
9620 @cindex SWV
9621 @cindex TPIU
9622
9623 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9624 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9625 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9626 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9627
9628 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9629 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9630 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9631 which causes quite some confusion.
9632 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9633 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9634
9635 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9636 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9637 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9638
9639 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9640 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9641 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9642 @end deffn
9643
9644 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9645 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9646 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9647 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9648
9649 @itemize @bullet
9650 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9651 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9652 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9653 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9654
9655 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9656 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9657 @end itemize
9658 @end deffn
9659
9660 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
9661 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9662 @end deffn
9663
9664 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
9665 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9666 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9667 at any time after the initialization, too.
9668 @end deffn
9669
9670 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9671 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9672 individually queried, to return its current value.
9673 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9674 @end deffn
9675
9676 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9677 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9678 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9679 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9680
9681 @itemize @bullet
9682 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9683 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9684
9685 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9686 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9687
9688 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9689 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9690
9691 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9692 protocol used for trace data:
9693 @itemize @minus
9694 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9695 data bits (default);
9696 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9697 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9698 @end itemize
9699
9700 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9701 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9702 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9703 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9704 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9705 of the TPIU.
9706
9707 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9708 the destination of the trace data:
9709 @itemize @minus
9710 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9711 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9712 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9713 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9714 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9715 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9716 each connected client;
9717 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9718 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9719 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9720 @end itemize
9721
9722 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9723 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9724 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9725 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9726
9727 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9728 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9729 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9730 maximum supported rate automatically.
9731
9732 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9733 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9734 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9735
9736 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9737 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9738 default value is @var{0}.
9739 @end itemize
9740 @end deffn
9741
9742 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
9743 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9744 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9745 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9746 data.
9747 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9748 after the @command{init}.
9749 @end deffn
9750
9751 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
9752 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9753 @end deffn
9754
9755
9756
9757 Example usage:
9758 @enumerate
9759 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9760 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9761 enough to:
9762 @example
9763 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9764 ...
9765 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9766 ...
9767 @end example
9768 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9769 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9770 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9771 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9772 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9773 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9774 @example
9775 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9776 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9777 @end example
9778 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9779 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9780 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9781 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9782 @example
9783 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9784 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9785 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9786 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9787 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9788 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9789 @end example
9790 @end enumerate
9791
9792 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9793 @cindex tracing
9794 @cindex SWO
9795 @cindex SWV
9796 @cindex ITM
9797 @cindex ETM
9798
9799 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9800 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9801 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9802 @end deffn
9803
9804 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9805 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9806 @end deffn
9807
9808 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9809 @cindex Cortex-M
9810
9811 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9812 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9813
9814 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9815 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9816 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9817 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9818 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9819 the step command leaves with the core running.
9820
9821 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9822 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9823 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9824 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9825
9826 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9827 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9828 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9829 does.
9830
9831 Default is @option{auto}.
9832 @end deffn
9833
9834 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9835 @cindex vector_catch
9836 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9837 for certain hardware events.
9838
9839 Parameters request interception of
9840 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9841 @option{none} of them,
9842 or one or more of the following:
9843 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9844 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9845 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9846 @option{irq_err},
9847 @option{state_err},
9848 @option{chk_err}, or
9849 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9850 @option{reset}.
9851 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9852 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9853 are mapped to HardFault.
9854 UsageFault checks for
9855 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9856 must also be explicitly enabled.
9857
9858 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9859 @end deffn
9860
9861 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9862 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9863 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9864
9865 @itemize @minus
9866 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9867 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9868 @end itemize
9869
9870 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9871 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9872 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9873 to manually reset the peripherals.
9874 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9875
9876 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9877 instead.
9878 @end deffn
9879
9880 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9881 @cindex ARMv8-A
9882 @cindex aarch64
9883
9884 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
9885 Display information about target caches
9886 @end deffn
9887
9888 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
9889 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9890 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9891 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9892 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9893 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9894 @end deffn
9895
9896 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9897 @cindex disassemble
9898 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9899 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9900 @end deffn
9901
9902 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9903 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9904 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9905 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9906 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9907 @end deffn
9908
9909 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9910 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9911 @option{on}.
9912 @end deffn
9913
9914 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9915 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9916 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9917 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9918 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9919 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9920 @end deffn
9921
9922 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9923
9924 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9925 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9926
9927 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9928
9929 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9930 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9931 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9932 @end deffn
9933
9934 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9935 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9936 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9937 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9938 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9939 @end deffn
9940
9941 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9942
9943 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
9944 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9945 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9946 @end deffn
9947
9948 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9949
9950 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9951 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9952 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9953 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9954 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9955 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9956 can be collected.
9957
9958 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9959 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9960 tooling.
9961
9962 @quotation Issues
9963 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9964 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9965 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9966 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9967
9968 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9969 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9970 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9971 software operation on the CPU.
9972 @end quotation
9973
9974 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9975 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9976 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9977 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9978 @end deffn
9979
9980 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
9981 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9982 @end deffn
9983
9984 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9985 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9986 control is disabled.
9987 @end deffn
9988
9989 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9990 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9991 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9992 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9993
9994 Supported trace formats:
9995 @itemize
9996 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9997 timing to be determined.
9998 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9999 addresses.
10000 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
10001 @end itemize
10002 @end deffn
10003
10004 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
10005 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
10006 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
10007 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10008
10009 Supported conditions:
10010 @itemize
10011 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
10012 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
10013 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
10014 instruction matches start data and mask.
10015 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
10016 instruction matches start data and mask.
10017 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
10018 data and mask.
10019 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10020 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10021 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10022 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
10023 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
10024 @end itemize
10025 @end deffn
10026
10027 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
10028 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
10029 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
10030 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10031
10032 Supported conditions:
10033 @itemize
10034 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
10035 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
10036 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
10037 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10038 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
10039 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10040 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
10041 data and mask.
10042 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10043 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10044 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10045 @end itemize
10046 @end deffn
10047
10048 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
10049 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
10050
10051 Supported triggers:
10052 @itemize
10053 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
10054 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
10055 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
10056 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
10057 collection.
10058 @end itemize
10059 @end deffn
10060
10061 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10062
10063 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10064 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10065 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10066 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10067 @end deffn
10068
10069 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10070 Display trace configuration.
10071 @end deffn
10072
10073 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10074 Display trace collection status.
10075 @end deffn
10076
10077 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10078 Start manual trace collection.
10079 @end deffn
10080
10081 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10082 Stop manual trace collection.
10083 @end deffn
10084
10085 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10086 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10087 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10088 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10089 @option{size} options using DMA.
10090 @end deffn
10091
10092 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10093 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10094 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10095 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10096 @option{size} options using DMA.
10097 @end deffn
10098
10099 @section Intel Architecture
10100
10101 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10102 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10103 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10104 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10105 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10106 @itemize
10107 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10108 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10109 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10110 @end itemize
10111
10112 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10113 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10114 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10115
10116 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10117 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10118 @end deffn
10119
10120 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10121 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10122 @end deffn
10123
10124 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10125 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10126 @end deffn
10127
10128 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10129 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10130 @end deffn
10131
10132 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10133 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10134 @end deffn
10135
10136 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10137 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10138 @end deffn
10139
10140 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10141
10142 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10143 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10144
10145 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10146 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10147 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10148 @end deffn
10149 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10150 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10151
10152 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10153
10154 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10155 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10156 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10157 @end deffn
10158
10159 @subsection Registers commands
10160 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10161 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10162 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10163
10164 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10165
10166 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10167 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10168 and "timer" groups.
10169
10170 @emph{example:}
10171 @example
10172 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10173 @end example
10174
10175 @end deffn
10176
10177 @section RISC-V Architecture
10178
10179 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10180 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10181 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10182 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10183 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10184 implement version 0.11.
10185
10186 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10187
10188 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10189 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10190 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10191
10192 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10193
10194 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10195 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
10196 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
10197
10198 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10199 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10200 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
10201 CSRs.
10202 @end deffn
10203
10204 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10205 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10206 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10207 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
10208 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10209 This command must be executed before `init`.
10210 @end deffn
10211
10212 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10213 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10214 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10215 @end deffn
10216
10217 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10218 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10219 deasserted.
10220 @end deffn
10221
10222 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
10223 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
10224 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
10225 @end deffn
10226
10227 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10228 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10229 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10230 on physical memory.
10231 @end deffn
10232
10233 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10234 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10235 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10236 performed on physical memory.
10237 @end deffn
10238
10239 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10240 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10241 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10242 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10243 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10244 race condition problem in your code.
10245
10246 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10247 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10248 @end deffn
10249
10250 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10251 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10252 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10253 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10254 values.
10255
10256 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10257 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10258 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10259 @end deffn
10260
10261 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10262 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10263 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10264 @end deffn
10265
10266 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10267 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10268 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10269 @end deffn
10270
10271 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10272 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10273 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10274 @end deffn
10275
10276 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10277 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10278 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10279 @end deffn
10280
10281 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10282
10283 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10284 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10285 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10286 @example
10287 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10288 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10289 @end example
10290
10291 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10292 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10293 @end deffn
10294
10295 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10296 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10297 @end deffn
10298
10299 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10300
10301 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10302 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10303
10304 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10305 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10306 @end deffn
10307
10308 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10309 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10310 @end deffn
10311
10312 @section ARC Architecture
10313 @cindex ARC
10314
10315 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10316 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10317 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10318 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10319 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10320 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10321 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10322 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10323 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10324 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10325 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10326 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10327 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10328 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10329 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10330
10331
10332 @subsection General ARC commands
10333
10334 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10335
10336 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10337 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10338 arguments:
10339
10340 @itemize @bullet
10341
10342 @item @code{-name} name
10343 @*Name of a register.
10344
10345 @item @code{-num} number
10346 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10347
10348 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10349 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10350
10351 @end itemize
10352
10353 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10354
10355 @itemize @bullet
10356
10357 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10358 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10359 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10360 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10361 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10362 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10363
10364 @item @code{-core}
10365 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10366 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10367 spaces.
10368
10369 @item @code{-bcr}
10370 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10371 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10372 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10373 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10374 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10375
10376 @item @code{-type} type_name
10377 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10378 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10379
10380 @item @code{-g}
10381 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10382 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10383 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10384 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10385 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10386
10387 @end itemize
10388
10389 @end deffn
10390
10391 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10392 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10393 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10394 @end deffn
10395
10396 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10397 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10398 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10399 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10400 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10401 startbit endbit}.
10402 @end deffn
10403
10404 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10405 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10406 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10407 @end deffn
10408
10409 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10410 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10411 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10412 @end deffn
10413
10414 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10415
10416 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10417 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10418 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10419 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10420
10421 @end deffn
10422
10423 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10424 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10425 registers.
10426 @end deffn
10427
10428 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10429 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10430 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10431 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10432
10433 @end deffn
10434
10435 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10436 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10437 registers.
10438 @end deffn
10439
10440 @section STM8 Architecture
10441 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10442 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10443
10444 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10445 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10446
10447 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10448 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10449 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10450 @cindex tracing
10451 @cindex libdcc
10452 @cindex DCC
10453 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10454 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10455 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10456 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10457
10458 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10459 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10460 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10461 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10462 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10463 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10464
10465 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10466 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10467 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10468 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10469 The target being debugged may
10470 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10471 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10472 each supported by a command:
10473
10474 @itemize
10475 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10476 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10477 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10478 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10479
10480 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10481 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10482 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10483
10484 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10485 and then displayed at any time.
10486 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10487
10488 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10489 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10490 @end itemize
10491
10492 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10493 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10494 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10495 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10496 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10497 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10498 does the same thing.
10499
10500 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10501 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10502 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10503 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10504 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10505
10506 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10507 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10508 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10509 @end deffn
10510
10511 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10512 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10513 in the order they triggered.
10514 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10515 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10516 history records.
10517 @end deffn
10518
10519 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10520 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10521 they have been triggered.
10522 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10523 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10524 and associates it with that identifier.
10525
10526 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10527 are not related except by this command.
10528 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10529 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10530 @end deffn
10531
10532
10533 @node JTAG Commands
10534 @chapter JTAG Commands
10535 @cindex JTAG Commands
10536 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10537 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10538 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10539 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10540 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10541
10542 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10543 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10544
10545 @itemize @bullet
10546 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10547 devices such as a CPUs.
10548 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10549 standard state machine (in parallel)
10550 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10551 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10552 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10553 while the reading previous ones.
10554 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10555 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10556 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10557 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10558 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10559 registers.
10560 @end itemize
10561
10562 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10563
10564 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10565 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10566 the order of TAP state transitions.
10567 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10568 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10569 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10570 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10571 these commands are not available.
10572
10573 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10574 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10575 that specify the entire register.
10576 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10577 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10578 The return value holds the original value of each
10579 of those fields.
10580
10581 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10582 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10583 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10584 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10585 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10586
10587 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10588 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10589
10590 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10591 in that state.
10592 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10593 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10594 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10595
10596 @quotation Warning
10597 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10598 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10599 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10600 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10601 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10602 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10603 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10604 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10605 @end quotation
10606 @end deffn
10607
10608 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
10609 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10610 This may be used for performance tuning.
10611
10612 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10613 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10614 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10615 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10616 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10617 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10618 @end deffn
10619
10620 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10621 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10622 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10623 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10624 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10625 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10626
10627 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10628 in that state.
10629 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10630 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10631 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10632
10633 @quotation Note
10634 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10635 register values, unlike data register values.
10636 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10637 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10638 @end quotation
10639 @end deffn
10640
10641 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10642 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10643 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10644 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10645 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10646 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10647 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10648 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10649 The final state must also be stable.
10650 @end deffn
10651
10652 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10653 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10654 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10655 Instructions often need some time
10656 to execute before they take effect.
10657 @end deffn
10658
10659 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10660 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10661
10662 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10663 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10664 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10665 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10666 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10667 @end deffn
10668
10669 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10670 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10671 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10672 must also be enabled.
10673 Default is enabled.
10674 @end deffn
10675
10676 @section TAP state names
10677 @cindex TAP state names
10678
10679 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10680 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10681 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10682 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10683
10684 @itemize @bullet
10685 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10686 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10687 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10688 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10689 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10690 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10691 through the data register
10692 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10693 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10694 for update or more shifting
10695 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10696 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10697 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10698 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10699 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10700 through the instruction register
10701 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10702 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10703 for update or more shifting
10704 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10705 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10706 @end itemize
10707
10708 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10709 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10710 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10711 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10712
10713 @itemize @bullet
10714 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10715 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10716 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10717 may not be as expected.
10718 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10719 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10720 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10721 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10722 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10723 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10724 @end itemize
10725
10726 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10727 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10728
10729 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10730 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10731 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10732 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10733
10734 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10735 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10736 @cindex SVF
10737
10738 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10739 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10740 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10741 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10742
10743 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10744 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10745 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10746 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10747
10748 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10749 affect their semantics.
10750
10751 Command options:
10752 @itemize @minus
10753 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10754 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10755 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10756 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10757 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10758 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10759 on the real interface;
10760 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10761 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10762 errors.
10763 @end itemize
10764 @end deffn
10765
10766 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10767 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10768 @cindex XSVF
10769
10770 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10771 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10772 Xilinx devices.
10773 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10774 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10775
10776 @quotation Important
10777 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10778 @end quotation
10779
10780 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10781 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10782 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10783 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10784 that TAP.
10785 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10786 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10787 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10788 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10789 @end deffn
10790
10791 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10792 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10793 after building the software.
10794 You may find them useful:
10795
10796 @itemize
10797 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10798 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10799 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10800 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10801 @end itemize
10802
10803 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10804 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10805 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10806 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10807 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10808 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10809 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10810
10811
10812 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
10813 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
10814 @cindex IPDBG
10815
10816 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
10817 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
10818 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
10819 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
10820 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
10821 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
10822
10823 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
10824 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
10825
10826 Command options:
10827 @itemize @bullet
10828 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
10829 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
10830 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
10831 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
10832 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
10833 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
10834 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
10835 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
10836 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
10837 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
10838 shift data through vir can be configured.
10839 @end itemize
10840 @end deffn
10841
10842 Examples:
10843 @example
10844 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
10845 @end example
10846 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
10847 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
10848
10849 @example
10850 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
10851 @end example
10852 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
10853 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
10854
10855 @node Utility Commands
10856 @chapter Utility Commands
10857 @cindex Utility Commands
10858
10859 @section RAM testing
10860 @cindex RAM testing
10861
10862 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10863 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10864 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10865 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10866 hardware problems.
10867
10868 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10869 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10870 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10871 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10872
10873 Load the memory testing functions with
10874
10875 @example
10876 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10877 @end example
10878
10879 to get access to the following facilities:
10880
10881 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
10882 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10883 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10884 @end deffn
10885
10886 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10887 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10888 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10889 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10890 @end deffn
10891
10892 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10893 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10894 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10895 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10896 @end deffn
10897
10898 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10899 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10900 @end deffn
10901
10902 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10903 @cindex Firmware recovery
10904
10905 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10906 devices recovery with JTAG.
10907
10908 For quickstart instructions run:
10909 @example
10910 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10911 @end example
10912
10913 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10914 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10915 @cindex GDB
10916 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10917 to debug remote targets.
10918 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10919
10920 @itemize
10921 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10922 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10923 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10924 as shown in this chapter.
10925 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10926 that also will probably need to be configured.
10927 @end itemize
10928
10929 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10930 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10931 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10932 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10933 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10934 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10935
10936 @section Connecting to GDB
10937 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10938 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10939 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10940 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10941 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10942
10943 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10944
10945 @enumerate
10946 @item
10947 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10948 @example
10949 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10950 @end example
10951 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10952
10953 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10954 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10955 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10956
10957 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10958 remote command above that becomes:
10959 @example
10960 tar ext :3333
10961 @end example
10962
10963 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10964 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10965 available through the command:
10966 @example
10967 target remote localhost:3333
10968 @end example
10969
10970 @item
10971 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10972 @example
10973 target extended-remote | \
10974 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10975 @end example
10976 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10977 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10978 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10979 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10980 @end enumerate
10981
10982 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10983 GDB command line.
10984
10985 @section Sample GDB session startup
10986
10987 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10988 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10989 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10990 small ARM program.
10991 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10992 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10993
10994 @example
10995 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10996 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10997 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10998 ...
10999 (gdb) monitor reset halt
11000 ...
11001 (gdb) load
11002 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
11003 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
11004 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
11005 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
11006 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
11007 (gdb) continue
11008 Continuing.
11009 ...
11010 @end example
11011
11012 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
11013 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
11014 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
11015 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
11016
11017 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
11018
11019 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
11020 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
11021 packet size and the device's memory map.
11022 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
11023 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
11024 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
11025
11026 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
11027 You may need to set those up by hand.
11028 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
11029 something like:
11030
11031 @example
11032 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
11033 @end example
11034
11035 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
11036
11037 @example
11038 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
11039 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
11040 @end example
11041
11042 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
11043 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
11044 do not have such restrictions.
11045
11046 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
11047 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
11048 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
11049 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
11050
11051 @section Programming using GDB
11052 @cindex Programming using GDB
11053 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
11054
11055 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
11056 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
11057 @example
11058 gdb_memory_map disable
11059 @end example
11060 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
11061 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
11062 working area.
11063
11064 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
11065 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
11066 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
11067 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
11068
11069 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
11070 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
11071
11072 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
11073 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
11074 @example
11075 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
11076 @end example
11077
11078 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
11079 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
11080
11081 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
11082 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
11083 will be used.
11084
11085 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
11086 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
11087 @example
11088 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
11089 @end example
11090 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
11091
11092 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11093 can be used.
11094
11095 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11096 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11097 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11098
11099 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11100 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11101 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11102
11103 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11104 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11105 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11106 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11107 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11108 without any intrusion of the target process.
11109
11110 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11111 Place following command after target configuration:
11112 @example
11113 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11114 @end example
11115
11116 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11117 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11118 @example
11119 gdb_memory_map disable
11120 @end example
11121
11122 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11123 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11124 @example
11125 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11126 @end example
11127
11128 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11129 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11130
11131 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11132 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11133 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11134 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11135
11136 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11137 previously shown variables.
11138
11139 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11140 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11141 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11142 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11143 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11144
11145 @section RTOS Support
11146 @cindex RTOS Support
11147 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11148
11149 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11150 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11151
11152 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11153 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11154 GDB commands.
11155
11156 @* An example setup is below:
11157
11158 @example
11159 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11160 @end example
11161
11162 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11163
11164 Currently supported rtos's include:
11165 @itemize @bullet
11166 @item @option{eCos}
11167 @item @option{ThreadX}
11168 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11169 @item @option{linux}
11170 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11171 @item @option{embKernel}
11172 @item @option{mqx}
11173 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11174 @item @option{nuttx}
11175 @item @option{RIOT}
11176 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11177 @item @option{Zephyr}
11178 @end itemize
11179
11180 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11181 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11182
11183 @table @code
11184 @item eCos symbols
11185 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11186 @item ThreadX symbols
11187 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11188 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11189 @raggedright
11190 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11191 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11192 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11193 @end raggedright
11194 @item linux symbols
11195 init_task.
11196 @item ChibiOS symbols
11197 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11198 @item embKernel symbols
11199 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11200 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11201 @item mqx symbols
11202 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11203 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11204 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11205 @item nuttx symbols
11206 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11207 @item RIOT symbols
11208 @raggedright
11209 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11210 _tcb_name_offset.
11211 @end raggedright
11212 @item Zephyr symbols
11213 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11214 @end table
11215
11216 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11217 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11218
11219 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11220 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11221
11222 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11223 along with the project:
11224
11225 @table @code
11226 @item FreeRTOS
11227 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11228 @item uC/OS-III
11229 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11230 @end table
11231
11232 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11233 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11234 @cindex SMP
11235 @cindex RTOS
11236 @cindex hwthread
11237 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11238 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11239 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11240 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11241 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11242 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11243 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11244 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11245 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11246
11247 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
11248 @quotation Note
11249 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
11250 @end quotation
11251
11252 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
11253 @itemize @bullet
11254 @item j - smp status request
11255 @item J - smp set request
11256 @end itemize
11257
11258 OpenOCD implements :
11259 @itemize @bullet
11260 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
11261 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
11262 @option{E01} for target not smp.
11263 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
11264 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
11265 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
11266 @end itemize
11267
11268 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
11269 @itemize @bullet
11270 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11271 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11272 @example
11273 set $_core 1
11274 #Jc01 packet is sent
11275 print $_core
11276 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11277 @end example
11278
11279 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11280 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11281
11282 @example
11283 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11284 define toggle0
11285 maint packet Jc0
11286 continue
11287 main packet Jc-1
11288 end
11289 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11290 define toggle1
11291 maint packet Jc1
11292 continue
11293 main packet Jc-1
11294 end
11295 @end example
11296 @end itemize
11297
11298 @node Tcl Scripting API
11299 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11300 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11301 @cindex Tcl scripts
11302 @section API rules
11303
11304 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11305 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11306 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11307
11308 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11309 pair list and lists.
11310
11311 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11312 list.
11313
11314 @example
11315 > set foo(me) Duane
11316 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11317 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11318 > set foo(duck) Donald
11319 @end example
11320
11321 If one does this:
11322
11323 @example
11324 > set foo
11325 @end example
11326
11327 The result is:
11328
11329 @example
11330 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11331 @end example
11332
11333 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11334
11335 @verbatim
11336 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11337 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11338 }
11339 @end verbatim
11340
11341 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11342 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11343
11344 @section Internal low-level Commands
11345
11346 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11347 invoke directly.
11348
11349 @itemize @bullet
11350 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11351
11352 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11353 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11354
11355 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11356 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11357
11358 Return information about the flash banks
11359
11360 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11361
11362 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11363 its execution. Example:
11364
11365 @example
11366 > capture "reset init"
11367 @end example
11368
11369 @end itemize
11370
11371 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11372 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11373 called "flash_banks".
11374
11375 @section Tcl RPC server
11376 @cindex RPC
11377
11378 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11379 commands and receive the results.
11380
11381 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11382 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11383 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11384 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11385 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11386
11387 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11388 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11389 @command{capture} command.
11390
11391 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11392
11393 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11394 @cindex RPC Notifications
11395
11396 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11397 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11398
11399 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11400 in the following format.
11401
11402 @verbatim
11403 type target_event event [event-name]
11404 type target_state state [state-name]
11405 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11406 @end verbatim
11407
11408 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11409 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11410 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11411 Defaults to off.
11412
11413 @end deffn
11414
11415 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11416 @cindex RPC trace output
11417
11418 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11419 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11420
11421 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11422
11423 @verbatim
11424 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11425 @end verbatim
11426
11427 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11428 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11429 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11430 Defaults to off.
11431
11432 See an example application here:
11433 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11434
11435 @end deffn
11436
11437 @node FAQ
11438 @chapter FAQ
11439 @cindex faq
11440 @enumerate
11441 @anchor{faqrtck}
11442 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11443 @cindex RTCK
11444 @cindex adaptive clocking
11445 @*
11446
11447 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11448 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11449 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11450 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11451
11452 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11453 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11454 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11455 @enumerate
11456 @item
11457 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11458 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11459 @item
11460 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11461 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11462 @end enumerate
11463
11464 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11465 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11466 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11467 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11468 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11469 power).
11470
11471 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11472 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11473 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11474 ARM926 scenario).
11475 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11476 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11477 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11478
11479 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11480 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11481 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11482 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11483
11484 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11485
11486 In order to make use of this,
11487 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11488 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11489
11490 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11491 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11492 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11493 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11494 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11495
11496 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11497 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11498 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11499 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11500
11501 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11502 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11503 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11504 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11505 with a CPLD.
11506 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11507 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11508 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11509 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11510 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11511 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11512
11513 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11514
11515 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11516
11517 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11518 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11519 depending on the chips on your board.
11520 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11521 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11522 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11523
11524 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11525 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11526 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11527
11528 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11529 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11530 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11531 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11532
11533 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11534 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11535 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11536 this way.
11537
11538 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11539 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11540 clock rate.
11541 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11542 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11543 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11544
11545 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11546
11547 @example
11548 # Example: 1.234MHz
11549 adapter speed 1234
11550 @end example
11551
11552
11553 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11554
11555 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11556 around Windows filenames.
11557
11558 @example
11559 > echo \a
11560
11561 > echo @{\a@}
11562 \a
11563 > echo "\a"
11564
11565 >
11566 @end example
11567
11568
11569 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11570
11571 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11572 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11573 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11574
11575 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11576 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11577 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11578
11579 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11580 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11581 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11582
11583 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11584
11585 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11586 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11587 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11588 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11589
11590 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11591 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11592 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11593
11594 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11595 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11596
11597 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11598 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11599 memory read caused data abort".
11600
11601 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11602 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11603 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11604 be done, feel free to add this here.
11605
11606 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11607 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11608 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11609 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11610 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11611 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11612 gracefully stops.
11613
11614 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11615 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11616 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11617
11618 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11619 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
11620 bytes. Painful...
11621
11622
11623 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11624 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11625
11626 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11627 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11628 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11629 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11630 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11631 reset, everything else should work fine.
11632
11633 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11634 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11635 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11636 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11637
11638 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11639 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11640 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11641 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11642
11643 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11644
11645 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11646 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11647 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11648
11649 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11650 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11651
11652 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11653 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11654 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11655 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11656 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11657 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11658 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11659 clock frequency?
11660
11661 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11662 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11663 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11664 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11665 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11666
11667 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11668
11669 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11670 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11671 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11672 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11673 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11674 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11675 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11676
11677 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11678
11679 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11680 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11681 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11682 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11683
11684 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11685 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11686 particular order?
11687
11688 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11689 the same order used by the hardware.
11690
11691 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11692 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11693 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11694 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11695 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11696 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11697
11698 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11699 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11700 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11701 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11702
11703 @itemize @bullet
11704 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11705 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11706 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11707 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11708 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11709 @end itemize
11710
11711 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11712
11713 @itemize @bullet
11714 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11715 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11716 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11717 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11718 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11719 @end itemize
11720
11721
11722 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11723 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11724 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11725
11726 TODO.
11727
11728 @end enumerate
11729
11730 @node Tcl Crash Course
11731 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11732 @cindex Tcl
11733
11734 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11735 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11736 how the Tcl scripts work.
11737
11738 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11739 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11740 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11741 OpenOCD.
11742
11743 @section Tcl Rule #1
11744 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11745 @enumerate
11746 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11747 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11748 @end enumerate
11749
11750 The Tcl equal is this:
11751
11752 @enumerate
11753 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11754 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11755 @end enumerate
11756
11757 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11758 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11759
11760 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11761 There is a second pair of rules.
11762 @enumerate
11763 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11764 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11765 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11766 in Tcl.
11767 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11768 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11769 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11770 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11771 @end enumerate
11772
11773 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11774 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11775 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11776 Everything is a string}
11777
11778 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11779 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11780 difference is subtle.
11781 @enumerate
11782 @item Parse Time
11783 @item Evaluation Time
11784 @end enumerate
11785
11786 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11787 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11788 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11789
11790 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11791 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11792 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11793 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11794
11795 @itemize @bullet
11796 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11797 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11798 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11799 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11800 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11801 @example
11802 # bash example
11803 X=`date`
11804 echo "The Date is: $X"
11805 # Tcl example
11806 set X [date]
11807 puts "The Date is: $X"
11808 @end example
11809 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11810 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11811 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11812 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11813 is a string}
11814 @example
11815 set x "Dinner"
11816 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11817 @end example
11818 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11819 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11820 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11821 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11822 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11823 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11824 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11825 @end itemize
11826
11827 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11828
11829 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11830
11831 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11832
11833 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11834 the normal way.
11835
11836 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11837 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11838 line is immediately executed.
11839
11840 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11841 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11842
11843 @subsection Command Execution
11844
11845 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11846 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11847 control flow operators.
11848
11849 Commands are executed like this:
11850
11851 @enumerate
11852 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11853 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11854 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11855 @end enumerate
11856
11857 It sort of works like this:
11858 @example
11859 for(;;)@{
11860 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11861
11862 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11863
11864 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11865 @}
11866 @end example
11867
11868 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11869 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11870 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11871 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11872 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11873 ``LookupCommand()''
11874
11875 @subsection The FOR command
11876
11877 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11878 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11879 command just like any other command.
11880
11881 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11882 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11883 are:
11884
11885 @enumerate 0
11886 @item The ascii text 'for'
11887 @item The start text
11888 @item The test expression
11889 @item The next text
11890 @item The body text
11891 @end enumerate
11892
11893 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11894 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11895 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11896 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11897
11898 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11899 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11900
11901 @example
11902 int
11903 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11904 int *argc,
11905 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11906 @end example
11907
11908 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11909 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11910 still operates in the same basic way.
11911
11912 @subsection FOR command implementation
11913
11914 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11915 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11916
11917 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11918
11919 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11920
11921 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11922 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11923 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11924
11925 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11926 expression and returns a value.
11927
11928 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11929 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11930 @example
11931 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11932
11933 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11934
11935 int
11936 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11937 int argc,
11938 char **argv )
11939 @{
11940 if( argc != 5 )@{
11941 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11942 return ERROR;
11943 @}
11944
11945 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11946
11947 // Execute the start statement.
11948 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11949
11950 // Top of loop test
11951 for(;;)@{
11952 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11953 if( i == 0 )
11954 break;
11955
11956 // Execute the body
11957 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11958
11959 // Execute the LOOP part
11960 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11961 @}
11962
11963 // Return no error
11964 SetResult( interp, "" );
11965 return SUCCESS;
11966 @}
11967 @end example
11968
11969 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11970 in the same basic way.
11971
11972 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11973
11974 @subsection source and find commands
11975 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11976 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11977 @*Remember the parsing rules
11978 @enumerate
11979 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11980 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11981 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11982 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11983 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11984 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11985 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11986 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11987 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11988 @end enumerate
11989 @subsection format command
11990 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11991 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11992 @b{sprintf()}.
11993 @b{Example}
11994 @example
11995 set x 6
11996 set y 7
11997 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11998 @end example
11999 @enumerate
12000 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
12001 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
12002 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
12003 @* Refer to Rule #1
12004 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
12005 @* Refer to Rule #1.
12006 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
12007 @end enumerate
12008 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
12009 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
12010 @example
12011 #1 Good
12012 proc someproc @{@} @{
12013 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
12014 @}
12015 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
12016 #2 Good - no variables
12017 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
12018 #3 Good Curly Braces
12019 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
12020 puts "Time: [date]"
12021 @}
12022 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
12023 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
12024 @end example
12025 @enumerate
12026 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
12027 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
12028 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
12029 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
12030 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
12031 command.
12032 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
12033 @*There are 4 examples:
12034 @enumerate
12035 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
12036 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
12037 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
12038 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
12039 @end enumerate
12040
12041 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
12042 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
12043 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
12044
12045 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
12046 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
12047 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
12048 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
12049 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
12050 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
12051 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
12052 @end enumerate
12053 @subsection Global Variables
12054 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
12055 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
12056 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
12057 @example
12058 proc myproc @{ @} @{
12059 set y 0 #Local variable Y
12060 global x #Global variable X
12061 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
12062 @}
12063 @end example
12064 @section Other Tcl Hacks
12065 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
12066 @example
12067 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
12068 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
12069 # Create var name
12070 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
12071 # Make it a global
12072 global $vn
12073 # Set it.
12074 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
12075 @}
12076 @end example
12077 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12078 @example
12079 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12080 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12081 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12082 @}
12083 @end example
12084
12085 @node License
12086 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
12087 @include fdl.texi
12088
12089 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12090 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12091 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12092 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12093 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12094 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12095
12096 @printindex cp
12097
12098 @node Command and Driver Index
12099 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12100 @printindex fn
12101
12102 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)